blob: 6e5649b525fa70a5cc9cc58359fa3c206d57008c [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau2e077f82019-11-25 20:36:16 +01005 version 2.2
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau4462af82020-06-26 22:01:04 +02007 2020/06/26
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020057
584. Proxies
594.1. Proxy keywords matrix
604.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
61
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100625. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200635.1. Bind options
645.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200655.3. Server DNS resolution
665.3.1. Global overview
675.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020068
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100696. Cache
706.1. Limitation
716.2. Setup
726.2.1. Cache section
736.2.2. Proxy section
74
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200757. Using ACLs and fetching samples
767.1. ACL basics
777.1.1. Matching booleans
787.1.2. Matching integers
797.1.3. Matching strings
807.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
817.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
827.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
837.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
847.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200857.3.1. Converters
867.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
877.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
887.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
897.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
907.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200917.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200927.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093
948. Logging
958.1. Log levels
968.2. Log formats
978.2.1. Default log format
988.2.2. TCP log format
998.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001008.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001018.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001028.3. Advanced logging options
1038.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1048.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1058.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1068.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1078.4. Timing events
1088.5. Session state at disconnection
1098.6. Non-printable characters
1108.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1118.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1128.9. Examples of logs
113
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001149. Supported filters
1159.1. Trace
1169.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001179.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001189.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001199.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200120
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012110. FastCGI applications
12210.1. Setup
12310.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12410.1.2. Proxy section
12510.1.3. Example
12610.2. Default parameters
12710.3. Limitations
128
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129
1301. Quick reminder about HTTP
131----------------------------
132
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100133When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
135on almost anything found in the contents.
136
137However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
138formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
139correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
140
141
1421.1. The HTTP transaction model
143-------------------------------
144
145The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100146to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100147from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
148connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149will involve a new connection :
150
151 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
152
153In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
154establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
155by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
156length.
157
158Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
159to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
160however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
161response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
162header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
163
164 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
165
166Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
167power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
168but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200169a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100171Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
173second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
174page :
175
176 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
177
178This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
179latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
180correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
181the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100182server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100184The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
185time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
186are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
187parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
188carry the stream identifier.
189
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100190By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
191connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
192leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100193start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
194processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
195waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200196
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200197HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100198 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
199 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100200 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100201 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200202 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100203
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100204For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
205the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100206server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
207is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
208servers.
209
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210
2111.2. HTTP request
212-----------------
213
214First, let's consider this HTTP request :
215
216 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100217 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200218 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
219 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
220 3 User-agent: my small browser
221 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
222 5 Accept: image/png
223
224
2251.2.1. The Request line
226-----------------------
227
228Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
229
230 - a METHOD : GET
231 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
232 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
233
234All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
235which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
236followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
237is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
238desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
239the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
240
241The URI itself can have several forms :
242
243 - A "relative URI" :
244
245 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
246
247 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
248 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
249
250 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
251
252 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
253
254 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
255 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
256 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
257 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
258 must accept this form too.
259
260 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
261 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
262 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100263
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200264 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
265 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
266 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
267 other protocols too.
268
269In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
270mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
271on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
272It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
273specific to the language, framework or application in use.
274
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100275HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100276assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100277However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
278received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
279processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
280as well as in server logs.
281
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200282
2831.2.2. The request headers
284--------------------------
285
286The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
287beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
288an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
289Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
290values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
291encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
292the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
293define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
294
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100295Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200296their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100297"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
298as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299
300The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
301that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
302is one valid form of empty line.
303
304Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
305headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
306about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
307application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
308
309Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000310 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200311 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
312 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
313 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
314
315
3161.3. HTTP response
317------------------
318
319An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
320messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
321
322 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100323 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200324 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
325 2 Content-length: 350
326 3 Content-Type: text/html
327
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200328As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
329codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
330response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100331continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
332the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
333following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
334sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
335(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
336correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
337such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
338state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
339over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
340if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
341information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200342
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200343
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003441.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200345------------------------
346
347Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
348
349 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
350 - a status code : 200
351 - a reason : OK
352
353The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100354 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
355 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
356 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
357 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
358 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000360Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100361"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200362found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
363messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
364or "Authentication Required".
365
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100366HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200367
368 Code When / reason
369 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
370 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100373 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
374 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200375 400 for an invalid or too large request
376 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
377 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200378 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100379 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200380 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100381 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
382 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200383 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
384 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
385 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200386 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200387 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
388 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
389 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
390
391The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3924.2).
393
394
3951.3.2. The response headers
396---------------------------
397
398Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
399the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
400details.
401
402
4032. Configuring HAProxy
404----------------------
405
4062.1. Configuration file format
407------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200408
409HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
410
411 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
412 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
413 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
414 "frontend" and "backend".
415
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100416The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
417referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200418delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100419
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200420
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004212.2. Quoting and escaping
422-------------------------
423
424HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
425many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
426with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
427single quotes.
428
429If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
430them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
431escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
432
433Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
434
435 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
436 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
437 \\ to use a backslash
438 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
439 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
440
441Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
442the interpretation of:
443
444 space as a parameter separator
445 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
446 # hash as a comment start
447
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200448Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
449-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
450backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
451
452Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200453quoting.
454
455Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
456nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
457
458Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
459equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
460
461 Example:
462 # those are equivalents:
463 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
464 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
465 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
466 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
467 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
468
469 # those are equivalents:
470 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
471 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
472 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
473 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
474
475
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004762.3. Environment variables
477--------------------------
478
479HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
480interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
481configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
482optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
483shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
484underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
485
486 Example:
487
488 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
489
490 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
491
492 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
493
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200494Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
495file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200496
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200497* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
498 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
499
500* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
501 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
502 directory.
503
504* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
505
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500506* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200507 processes, separated by semicolons.
508
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500509* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200510 CLI, separated by semicolons.
511
512See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200513
5142.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200515----------------
516
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100517Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100518values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
519otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
520numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
521for every keyword. Supported units are :
522
523 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
524 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
525 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
526 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
527 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
528 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
529
530
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005312.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200532-------------
533
534 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
535 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
536 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
537 global
538 daemon
539 maxconn 256
540
541 defaults
542 mode http
543 timeout connect 5000ms
544 timeout client 50000ms
545 timeout server 50000ms
546
547 frontend http-in
548 bind *:80
549 default_backend servers
550
551 backend servers
552 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
553
554
555 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
556 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
557 global
558 daemon
559 maxconn 256
560
561 defaults
562 mode http
563 timeout connect 5000ms
564 timeout client 50000ms
565 timeout server 50000ms
566
567 listen http-in
568 bind *:80
569 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
570
571
572Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
573
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100574 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200575
576
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005773. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200578--------------------
579
580Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
581are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
582of them have command-line equivalents.
583
584The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
585
586 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200587 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200588 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200589 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200590 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200591 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200592 - description
593 - deviceatlas-json-file
594 - deviceatlas-log-level
595 - deviceatlas-separator
596 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900597 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200598 - gid
599 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100600 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200601 - h1-case-adjust
602 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100603 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100604 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100605 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200606 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200607 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200608 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100609 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200610 - lua-load
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100611 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200612 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200613 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200614 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200615 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200616 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200617 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100618 - presetenv
619 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200620 - uid
621 - ulimit-n
622 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200623 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100624 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200625 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200626 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200627 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200628 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200629 - ssl-default-bind-options
630 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200631 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200632 - ssl-default-server-options
633 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100634 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200635 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100636 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100637 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100638 - 51degrees-data-file
639 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200640 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200641 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200642 - wurfl-data-file
643 - wurfl-information-list
644 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200645 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100646 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100647
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200648 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100649 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200650 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200651 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200652 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100653 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100654 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100655 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200656 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200657 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200658 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200659 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200660 - noepoll
661 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000662 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200663 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100664 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300665 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000666 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100667 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200668 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200669 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200670 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000671 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000672 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200673 - tune.buffers.limit
674 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200675 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200676 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100677 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +0200678 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200679 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200680 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200681 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100682 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200683 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200684 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +0200685 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100686 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100687 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100688 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100689 - tune.lua.session-timeout
690 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200691 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100692 - tune.maxaccept
693 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200694 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200695 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200696 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +0200697 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
698 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100699 - tune.rcvbuf.client
700 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100701 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200702 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +0200703 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100704 - tune.sndbuf.client
705 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100706 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100707 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200708 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100709 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200710 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200711 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100712 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200713 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100714 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200715 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
716 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
717 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100718 - tune.zlib.memlevel
719 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100720
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200721 * Debugging
722 - debug
723 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +0200724 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200725
726
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007273.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200728------------------------------------
729
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200730ca-base <dir>
731 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +0100732 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
733 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
734 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200735
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200736chroot <jail dir>
737 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
738 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
739 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
740 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
741 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100742 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100743
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100744cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
745 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
746 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
747 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
748 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
749 set. These sets have the format
750
751 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
752
753 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100754 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100755 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
756 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100757 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
758 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100759 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100760 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100761 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100762 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100763 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
764 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
765 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
766 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100767
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100768 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
769 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
770 on the machine's word size.
771
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100772 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100773 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
774 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
775 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
776 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
777 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
778 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100779
780 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100781 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
782
783 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
784 # first 4 CPUs
785
786 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
787 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
788 # word size.
789
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100790 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100791 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100792 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
793 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
794 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
795
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100796 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
797 # and so on.
798 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
799 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
800 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
801
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100802 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100803 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
804 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
805 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
806
807 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
808 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
809 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
810
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100811 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
812 # and a thread range.
813 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
814 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
815 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
816
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200817crt-base <dir>
818 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +0100819 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
820 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200821
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200822daemon
823 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
824 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100825 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
826 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200827
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200828deviceatlas-json-file <path>
829 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100830 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200831
832deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100833 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200834 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
835
836deviceatlas-separator <char>
837 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
838 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
839
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100840deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200841 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
842 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
843 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100844
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900845external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100846 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
847 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100848 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
849 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
850 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
851 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
852 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900853
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200854gid <number>
855 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
856 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
857 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100858 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
859 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200860 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100861
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100862group <group name>
863 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
864 See also "gid" and "user".
865
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100866hard-stop-after <time>
867 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
868
869 Arguments :
870 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
871 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
872 SIGUSR1 signal.
873
874 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
875 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
876 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
877
878 Example:
879 global
880 hard-stop-after 30s
881
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200882h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
883 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
884 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
885 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
886 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +0500887 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200888 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
889 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
890 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
891 specified in a proxy.
892
893 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
894 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
895 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
896 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
897 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
898 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
899 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
900
901 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
902 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
903 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
904 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
905 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
906
907 Example:
908 global
909 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
910
911 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
912 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
913
914h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
915 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
916 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
917 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
918 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
919 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
920 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
921 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
922 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
923
924 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
925 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
926 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
927
928 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
929 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
930
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100931insecure-fork-wanted
932 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
933 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
934 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
935 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
936 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
937 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
938 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
939 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
940 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
941 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
942 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
943 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
944 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
945 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
946 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
947 disable it.
948
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100949insecure-setuid-wanted
950 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
951 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
952 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
953 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
954 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
955 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
956 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
957 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
958 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
959 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
960 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
961 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
962 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
963 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
964
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100965issuers-chain-path <dir>
966 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
967 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
968 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
969 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
970 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
971 "issuers-chain-path".
972 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
973 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
974 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
975 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
976 will share the chain in memory.
977
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200978localpeer <name>
979 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
980 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
981 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
982 the configuration parsing.
983
984 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
985 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
986
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200987log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
988 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100989 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100990 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100991 configured with "log global".
992
993 <address> can be one of:
994
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100995 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100996 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
997 port).
998
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100999 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1000 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1001 port).
1002
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001003 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001004 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1005 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001006 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001007
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001008 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1009 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1010 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1011 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1012 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1013 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1014 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1015 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1016 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1017 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1018 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1019 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1020 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1021 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001022 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1023 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001024
1025 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1026 "fd@2", see above.
1027
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001028 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1029 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1030 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1031 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1032 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1033
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001034 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1035 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001036
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001037 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1038 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1039 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1040 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1041 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1042 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1043 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1044 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1045 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1046 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001047 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1048 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001049
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001050 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1051 one of the following :
1052
1053 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1054 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1055
1056 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1057 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1058
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001059 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1060 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1061 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1062 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1063 logger consumes.
1064
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001065 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1066 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1067 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1068 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1069
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001070 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1071 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1072 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1073 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1074 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1075
1076 <sample_size>
1077 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1078 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1079 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1080 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1081 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1082
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001083 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001084
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001085 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1086 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1087 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1088
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001089 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1090 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1091 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1092 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001093
1094 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001095 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1096 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1097 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1098 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1099 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1100 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001101
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001102 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001103
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001104log-send-hostname [<string>]
1105 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1106 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1107 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1108 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1109 the logs.
1110
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001111log-tag <string>
1112 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1113 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1114 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001115 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001116
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001117lua-load <file>
1118 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1119 used multiple times.
1120
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001121lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1122 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1123 variable.
1124 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1125 to "path".
1126
1127 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1128 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1129 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1130 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1131 will be checked earlier.
1132
1133 As an example by specifying the following path:
1134
1135 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1136 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1137
1138 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1139 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1140 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1141 paths if that does not exist either.
1142
1143 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1144 documentation.
1145
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001146master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001147 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1148 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1149 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001150 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001151 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1152 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001153 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1154 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1155 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1156 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1157 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001158
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001159 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001160
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001161mworker-max-reloads <number>
1162 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001163 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001164 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1165 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1166 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1167
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001168nbproc <number>
1169 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1170 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1171 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001172 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1173 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001174 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1175 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001176
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001177nbthread <number>
1178 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001179 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1180 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1181 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1182 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1183 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001184 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1185 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1186 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1187 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1188 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1189 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1190 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001191
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001192pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001193 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001194 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1195 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1196
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001197pp2-never-send-local
1198 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1199 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1200 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1201 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1202 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1203 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1204 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1205 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1206 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1207 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1208 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1209
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001210presetenv <name> <value>
1211 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1212 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1213 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1214 and "unsetenv".
1215
1216resetenv [<name> ...]
1217 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1218 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1219 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1220 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1221 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1222 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1223 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1224 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1225
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001226stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001227 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1228 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1229 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1230 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1231 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1232 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001233 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001234 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1235 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1236 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1237 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001238
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001239server-state-base <directory>
1240 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001241 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1242 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001243
1244server-state-file <file>
1245 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1246 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1247 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1248 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1249 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1250 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1251 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1252 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001253 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1254 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001255
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001256setenv <name> <value>
1257 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1258 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1259 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1260 and "unsetenv".
1261
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001262set-dumpable
1263 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001264 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1265 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1266 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1267 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1268 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1269 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1270 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1271 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1272 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1273 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1274 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1275 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1276 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1277 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1278 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1279 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1280 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001281
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001282ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1283 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1284 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001285 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001286 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001287 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1288 information and recommendations see e.g.
1289 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1290 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1291 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1292 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001293
1294ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1295 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1296 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1297 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1298 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1299 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001300 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1301 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1302 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001303 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001304
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001305ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1306 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1307 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1308 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1309 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1310 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1311
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001312ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1313 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1314 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1315 keyword to see available options.
1316
1317 Example:
1318 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001319 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001320
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001321ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1322 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1323 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001324 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001325 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001326 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1327 information and recommendations see e.g.
1328 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1329 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1330 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1331 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1332 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001333
1334ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1335 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1336 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1337 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1338 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1339 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001340 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1341 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1342 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1343 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001344
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001345ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1346 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1347 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1348 keyword to see available options.
1349
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001350ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1351 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1352 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1353 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001354 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001355 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001356 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1357 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1358 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1359 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001360 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1361 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1362 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1363
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001364ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001365 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
1366 the loading of the SSL certificates.
1367
1368 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1369 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1370 optimize the startup time.
1371
1372 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1373 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1374 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1375
1376 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001377 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001378
1379 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
1380 will try to load a certificate bundle. This is done by looking for
1381 <basename>.rsa, .ecdsa and .dsa. In the case of directories, HAProxy will
1382 try to gather the files with the same basename in a multi-certificate bundle.
1383 The bundles were introduced with OpenSSL 1.0.2 and were the only way back
1384 then to load an ECDSA certificate and a RSA one, with the same SNI. Since
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001385 OpenSSL 1.1.1 it is not recommended anymore, you can specify both the ECDSA
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001386 and the RSA file on the bind line.
1387
1388 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1389
1390 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1391
1392 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1393 not provided in the PEM file.
1394
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001395 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1396 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1397
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001398 The default behavior is "all".
1399
1400 Example:
1401 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1402 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1403 ssl-load-extra-files none
1404
1405 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1406
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001407ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1408 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1409 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1410 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1411
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001412ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
1413 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the enchor for chain validation: as a
1414 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1415 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1416 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1417 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1418 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1419 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
1420 bits does not need it.
1421
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001422stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1423 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1424 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1425 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001426 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001427 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001428
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001429 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1430 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1431 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001432
1433stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1434 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1435 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001436 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001437
1438stats maxconn <connections>
1439 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1440 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1441
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001442uid <number>
1443 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1444 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1445 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1446 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1447
1448ulimit-n <number>
1449 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1450 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1451 option.
1452
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001453unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1454 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1455
1456 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1457 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1458 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1459 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1460 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1461 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1462 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1463 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1464 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1465 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1466
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001467unsetenv [<name> ...]
1468 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1469 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1470 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1471 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1472 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1473 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1474 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1475
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001476user <user name>
1477 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1478 See also "uid" and "group".
1479
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001480node <name>
1481 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1482
1483 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1484 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1485 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1486 traffic.
1487
1488description <text>
1489 Add a text that describes the instance.
1490
1491 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1492 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1493 "<" and ">" characters.
1494
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100149551degrees-data-file <file path>
1496 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001497 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001498
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001499 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001500 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1501
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000150251degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001503 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1504 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1505 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1506
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001507 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001508 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1509
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200151051degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001511 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1512 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1513
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001514 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1515 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1516
151751degrees-cache-size <number>
1518 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1519 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1520 By default, this cache is disabled.
1521
1522 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001523 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1524
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001525wurfl-data-file <file path>
1526 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1527 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1528
1529 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1530 with USE_WURFL=1.
1531
1532wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1533 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1534 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1535 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1536
1537 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1538
1539 Valid WURFL properties are:
1540 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1541
1542 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1543 device.
1544
1545 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1546 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1547
1548 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1549 particular web request.
1550
1551 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1552 used Libwurfl API version.
1553
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001554 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1555 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1556
1557 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1558 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1559
1560 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1561
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001562 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1563 with USE_WURFL=1.
1564
1565wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1566 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1567 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1568
1569 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1570 with USE_WURFL=1.
1571
1572wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1573 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1574 thus before the chroot.
1575
1576 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1577 with USE_WURFL=1.
1578
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001579wurfl-cache-size <size>
1580 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1581 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001582 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001583 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001584
1585 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1586 with USE_WURFL=1.
1587
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001588strict-limits
1589 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy is tries to set
1590 the best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it
1591 will emit a warning. Use this option if you want an explicit failure of
1592 haproxy when those limits fail. This option is disabled by default. If it has
1593 been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no"
1594 keyword.
1595
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015963.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001597-----------------------
1598
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001599busy-polling
1600 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1601 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1602 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1603 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1604 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1605 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1606 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1607 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1608 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1609 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1610 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1611 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1612 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1613 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1614 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1615 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1616 "poll" pollers.
1617
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001618 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1619 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1620 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1621
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001622max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1623 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1624 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1625 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1626 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1627 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1628 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1629 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1630 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1631
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001632maxconn <number>
1633 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1634 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1635 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001636 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1637 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1638 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1639 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001640 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1641 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1642 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1643 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1644 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1645 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001646
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001647maxconnrate <number>
1648 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1649 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1650 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1651 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1652 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1653 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1654 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1655 fairness.
1656
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001657maxcomprate <number>
1658 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001659 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001660 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1661 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1662 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001663 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001664 default value.
1665
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001666maxcompcpuusage <number>
1667 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1668 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1669 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1670 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1671 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1672 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1673 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1674 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1675
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001676maxpipes <number>
1677 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1678 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1679 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1680 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1681 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1682 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1683
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001684maxsessrate <number>
1685 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1686 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1687 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1688 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1689 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1690 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1691 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1692 fairness.
1693
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001694maxsslconn <number>
1695 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1696 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1697 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1698 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1699 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1700 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1701 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001702 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1703 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1704 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1705 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1706 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1707 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1708 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001709
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001710maxsslrate <number>
1711 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1712 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1713 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1714 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1715 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1716 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1717 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1718 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1719 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1720 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1721
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001722maxzlibmem <number>
1723 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1724 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1725 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001726 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1727 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1728 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1729
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001730noepoll
1731 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1732 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001733 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001734
1735nokqueue
1736 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1737 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1738 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1739
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001740noevports
1741 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1742 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1743 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1744 also "nopoll".
1745
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001746nopoll
1747 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1748 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001749 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001750 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1751 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001752
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001753nosplice
1754 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001755 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001756 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001757 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001758 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1759 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1760 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1761 "option splice-response".
1762
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001763nogetaddrinfo
1764 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1765 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1766
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001767noreuseport
1768 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1769 command line argument "-dR".
1770
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001771profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1772 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1773 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1774 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1775 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001776 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001777 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1778 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1779 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1780 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1781
1782 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1783 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1784 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1785 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1786 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001787 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1788 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1789 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1790 CLI.
1791
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001792spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001793 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1794 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1795 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1796 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1797 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1798 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001799
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001800ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001801 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001802 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001803 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1804 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1805 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1806 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1807 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001808 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1809 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001810 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1811 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1812 openssl configuration file uses:
1813 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1814
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001815ssl-mode-async
1816 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001817 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001818 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1819 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1820 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001821 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001822 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001823
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001824tune.buffers.limit <number>
1825 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1826 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1827 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1828 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1829 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001830 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001831 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1832 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1833 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1834 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1835 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1836 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1837 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1838 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1839 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1840
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001841tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1842 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1843 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1844 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1845 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1846
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001847tune.bufsize <number>
1848 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1849 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1850 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1851 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1852 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1853 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1854 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001855 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1856 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1857 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001858 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001859 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1860 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1861 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001862
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001863tune.chksize <number>
1864 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1865 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1866 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1867 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1868 checks whenever possible.
1869
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001870tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1871 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1872 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1873 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1874 this value. The default value is 1.
1875
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001876tune.fail-alloc
1877 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1878 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1879 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1880 gracefully.
1881
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001882tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
1883 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
1884 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
1885 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
1886 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
1887 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
1888
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001889tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1890 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1891 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1892 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1893 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1894 change it.
1895
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001896tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1897 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001898 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1899 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001900 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1901 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1902 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1903 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1904 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1905
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001906tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1907 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1908 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1909 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1910 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1911 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1912 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1913 recommended not to change this value.
1914
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001915tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1916 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1917 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1918 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1919 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1920 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1921 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1922 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1923
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001924tune.http.cookielen <number>
1925 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1926 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1927 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1928 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1929 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1930 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1931 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1932 to change this value.
1933
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001934tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001935 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1936 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001937 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001938 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001939 configuration directives too.
1940 The default value is 1024.
1941
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001942tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1943 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1944 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1945 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1946 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1947 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1948 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001949 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1950 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1951 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001952
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001953tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
1954 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
1955 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
1956 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
1957 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
1958 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
1959 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
1960 this option to "off". The default is on.
1961
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001962tune.idletimer <timeout>
1963 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1964 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1965 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1966 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1967 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1968 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001969 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001970 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001971 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1972
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001973tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1974 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1975 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1976 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1977 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1978 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1979 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1980 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1981 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1982 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1983
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001984tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1985 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001986 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001987 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1988 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001989 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001990 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1991 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1992
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001993tune.lua.maxmem
1994 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1995 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1996 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1997 memory.
1998
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001999tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2000 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002001 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2002 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002003 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002004
2005tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2006 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2007 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2008 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2009 check servers.
2010
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002011tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2012 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2013 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2014 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002015 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002016
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002017tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002018 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2019 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
2020 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
2021 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
2022 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
2023 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
2024 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
2025 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
2026 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
2027 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002028
2029tune.maxpollevents <number>
2030 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2031 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2032 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2033 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2034 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2035
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002036tune.maxrewrite <number>
2037 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2038 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2039 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2040 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2041 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2042 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2043 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2044 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2045 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2046 bufsize.
2047
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002048tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2049 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2050 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2051 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2052 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2053 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2054 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2055 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2056 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2057 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002058 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2059 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002060 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2061 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2062 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2063 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2064 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2065 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2066 setting this parameter to 0.
2067
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002068tune.pipesize <number>
2069 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2070 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2071 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2072 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2073 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2074 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2075
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002076tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2077 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2078 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2079 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2080 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2081 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2082 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002083 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002084
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002085tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2086 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2087 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2088 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2089 default is 20.
2090
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002091tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2092tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2093 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2094 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2095 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002096 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002097 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002098 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2099 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2100
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002101tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002102 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002103 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2104 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2105 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2106 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2107
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002108tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002109 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002110 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002111 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead. When
2112 experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2113 tune.sched.low-latency to limit the maximum latency to the lowest possible.
2114
2115tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2116 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
2117 haproxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
2118 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2119 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2120 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2121 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2122 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2123 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2124 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002125
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002126tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2127tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2128 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2129 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2130 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002131 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002132 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002133 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2134 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2135 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2136 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2137 notifying haproxy again.
2138
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002139tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002140 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2141 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2142 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002143 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002144 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002145 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002146 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2147 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2148 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002149 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2150 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002151
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002152tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002153 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002154 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2155 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2156 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2157 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2158 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2159
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002160tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2161 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002162 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002163 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2164 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2165 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2166 being used for too long.
2167
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002168tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2169 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2170 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2171 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2172 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2173 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2174 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2175 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2176 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2177 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2178 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002179 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002180 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002181
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002182tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2183 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2184 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2185 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2186 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002187 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002188 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2189 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002190 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2191 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002192
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002193tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2194 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2195 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2196 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2197 1000 entries.
2198
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002199tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2200 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2201 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2202 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2203
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002204tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002205tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002206tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2207tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2208tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002209 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2210 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2211 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2212 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2213 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2214 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2215 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2216 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002217
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002218 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2219 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2220 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2221 all available space is consumed.
2222 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2223 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2224 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002225
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002226tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2227 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002228 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002229 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002230 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002231 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2232
2233tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2234 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2235 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002236 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2237 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002238
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022393.3. Debugging
2240--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002241
Willy Tarreau1b857852020-02-25 11:27:22 +01002242debug (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002243 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2244 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2245 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2246 system startup.
2247
2248quiet
2249 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2250 line argument "-q".
2251
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002252zero-warning
2253 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2254 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2255 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2256 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2257 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2258 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2259
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002260
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010022613.4. Userlists
2262--------------
2263It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2264http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2265it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2266
2267userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002268 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002269 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2270
2271group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002272 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002273 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2274 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2275
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002276user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2277 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002278 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2279 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002280 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2281 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2282 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2283 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002284
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002285 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2286 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2287 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2288 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2289 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2290 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2291 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2292 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2293 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002294
2295 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002296 userlist L1
2297 group G1 users tiger,scott
2298 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002299
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002300 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2301 user scott insecure-password elgato
2302 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002303
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002304 userlist L2
2305 group G1
2306 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002307
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002308 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2309 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2310 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002311
2312 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002313
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002314
23153.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002316----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002317It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2318several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2319instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2320values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2321automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2322In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2323using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2324tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2325reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2326Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2327that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2328each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002329
2330peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002331 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002332 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2333
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002334bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2335 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2336 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2337
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002338disabled
2339 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2340 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2341 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2342
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002343default-bind [param*]
2344 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2345
2346default-server [param*]
2347 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2348
2349 Arguments:
2350 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2351 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2352 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2353 details.
2354
2355
2356 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2357
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002358enable
2359 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2360
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002361log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2362 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2363 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2364 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2365 more details.
2366
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002367peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002368 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2369 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002370 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
2371 haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
2372 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2373 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2374 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002375
2376 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2377 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2378
2379 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002380 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2381 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2382 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002383
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002384 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2385 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002386
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002387 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2388 "server" keyword explanation below).
2389
2390server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002391 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002392 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2393 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2394 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2395 of this "peers" section).
2396 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2397
2398
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002399 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002400 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002401 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002402 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2403 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2404 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002405
2406 backend mybackend
2407 mode tcp
2408 balance roundrobin
2409 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2410 stick on src
2411
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002412 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2413 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002414
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002415 Example:
2416 peers mypeers
2417 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2418 default-server ssl verify none
2419 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2420 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002421
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002422
2423table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2424 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2425
2426 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2427 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002428 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002429 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2430 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2431 "stick-table" keyword).
2432
2433 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2434 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2435 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2436 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2437 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2438 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2439 of the stick-table name as follows:
2440
2441 peers mypeers
2442 peer A ...
2443 peer B ...
2444 table t1 ...
2445
2446 frontend fe1
2447 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2448
2449 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2450 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2451
2452 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2453 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2454 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2455 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2456 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2457 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2458 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2459
2460 peers mypeers
2461 peer A ...
2462 peer B ...
2463 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2464
2465 backend t1
2466 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2467
2468 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2469 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2470 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2471
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090024723.6. Mailers
2473------------
2474It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2475If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2476in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2477
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002478mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002479 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2480 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2481
2482mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2483 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2484
2485 Example:
2486 mailers mymailers
2487 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2488 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2489
2490 backend mybackend
2491 mode tcp
2492 balance roundrobin
2493
2494 email-alert mailers mymailers
2495 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2496 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2497
2498 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2499 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2500
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002501timeout mail <time>
2502 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2503 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2504 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2505 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2506
2507 Example:
2508 mailers mymailers
2509 timeout mail 20s
2510 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002511
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020025123.7. Programs
2513-------------
2514In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2515master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2516managed the same way as the workers.
2517
2518During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2519sequence as a worker:
2520
2521 - the master is re-executed
2522 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2523 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2524 instance of the program
2525
2526During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2527
2528program <name>
2529 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2530 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2531 the management guide).
2532
2533command <command> [arguments*]
2534 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2535 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2536 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2537 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2538
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002539user <user name>
2540 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2541 See also "group".
2542
2543group <group name>
2544 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2545 See also "user".
2546
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002547option start-on-reload
2548no option start-on-reload
2549 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2550 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2551 program section.
2552
2553
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010025543.8. HTTP-errors
2555----------------
2556
2557It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2558imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2559several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2560
2561http-errors <name>
2562 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2563 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2564
2565errorfile <code> <file>
2566 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2567
2568 Arguments :
2569 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02002570 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
2571 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002572
2573 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2574 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2575 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2576 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2577 before any chroot is performed.
2578
2579 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2580
2581 Example:
2582 http-errors website-1
2583 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2584 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2585 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2586
2587 http-errors website-2
2588 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2589 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2590 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2591
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020025923.9. Rings
2593----------
2594
2595It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
2596servers or traces.
2597
2598ring <ringname>
2599 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
2600
2601description <text>
2602 The descritpition is an optional description string of the ring. It will
2603 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
2604
2605format <format>
2606 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
2607
2608 Arguments:
2609 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
2610 one of the following :
2611
2612 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
2613 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
2614 designed to be used with a local log server.
2615
2616 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
2617 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2618 used in containers or during development, where the severity
2619 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
2620 is the default.
2621
2622 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
2623 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
2624
2625 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
2626 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
2627
2628 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2629 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
2630 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
2631 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
2632 logger consumes.
2633
2634 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2635 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
2636 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2637 used with a local log server.
2638
2639maxlen <length>
2640 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
2641 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
2642 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
2643
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002644server <name> <address> [param*]
2645 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
2646 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
2647 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
2648 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
2649 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
2650 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
2651 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
2652 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
2653 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02002654 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
2655 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002656
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002657size <size>
2658 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
2659 set to BUFSIZE.
2660
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002661timeout connect <timeout>
2662 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2663
2664 Arguments :
2665 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2666 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2667 as explained at the top of this document.
2668
2669timeout server <timeout>
2670 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
2671
2672 Arguments :
2673 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2674 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2675 as explained at the top of this document.
2676
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002677 Example:
2678 global
2679 log ring@myring local7
2680
2681 ring myring
2682 description "My local buffer"
2683 format rfc3164
2684 maxlen 1200
2685 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002686 timeout connect 5s
2687 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02002688 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002689
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002690
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026914. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002692----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002693
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002694Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002695 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002696 - frontend <name>
2697 - backend <name>
2698 - listen <name>
2699
2700A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2701its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2702section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002703section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002704
2705A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2706connections.
2707
2708A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2709to forward incoming connections.
2710
2711A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2712parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2713
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002714All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2715'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2716case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2717
2718Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2719logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2720proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2721However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2722name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2723
2724Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2725and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002726bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002727protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2728modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2729arbitrary criteria.
2730
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002731In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2732a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002733the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002734
2735 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2736 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2737 between responses and new requests.
2738
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002739 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2740 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2741 client-facing connection remains open.
2742
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002743 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2744 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002745
2746The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2747frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2748following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002749weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002750
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002751 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002752
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002753 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2754 ----+-----+-----+----
2755 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2756 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002757 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2758 ----+-----+-----+----
2759 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002760
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002761
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002762
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020027634.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2764--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002765
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002766The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2767limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2768they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2769limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002770marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002771option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002772and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2773with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2774specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002775
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002776
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002777 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2778------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2779acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002780backlog X X X -
2781balance X - X X
2782bind - X X -
2783bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002784capture cookie - X X -
2785capture request header - X X -
2786capture response header - X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002787compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002788cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002789declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002790default-server X - X X
2791default_backend X X X -
2792description - X X X
2793disabled X X X X
2794dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002795email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002796email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002797email-alert mailers X X X X
2798email-alert myhostname X X X X
2799email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002800enabled X X X X
2801errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002802errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002803errorloc X X X X
2804errorloc302 X X X X
2805-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2806errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002807force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002808filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002809fullconn X - X X
2810grace X X X X
2811hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01002812http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02002813http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002814http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002815http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002816http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02002817http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002818http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002819http-check set-var X - X X
2820http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02002821http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002822http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002823http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002824http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002825http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002826id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002827ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002828load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002829log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002830log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002831log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002832log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002833max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002834maxconn X X X -
2835mode X X X X
2836monitor fail - X X -
2837monitor-net X X X -
2838monitor-uri X X X -
2839option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2840option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2841option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2842option allbackups (*) X - X X
2843option checkcache (*) X - X X
2844option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2845option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02002846option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002847option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2848option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002849-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2850option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002851option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2852option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002853option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002854option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002855option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002856option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002857option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002858option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2859option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2860option httpchk X - X X
2861option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002862option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002863option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002864option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002865option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002866option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002867option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2868option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2869option logasap (*) X X X -
2870option mysql-check X - X X
2871option nolinger (*) X X X X
2872option originalto X X X X
2873option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002874option pgsql-check X - X X
2875option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002876option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002877option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002878option smtpchk X - X X
2879option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2880option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2881option splice-request (*) X X X X
2882option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002883option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002884option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2885option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2886-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002887option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002888option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2889option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2890option tcpka X X X X
2891option tcplog X X X X
2892option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002893external-check command X - X X
2894external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002895persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2896rate-limit sessions X X X -
2897redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002898-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002899retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002900retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002901server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002902server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002903server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002904source X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002905stats admin - X X X
2906stats auth X X X X
2907stats enable X X X X
2908stats hide-version X X X X
2909stats http-request - X X X
2910stats realm X X X X
2911stats refresh X X X X
2912stats scope X X X X
2913stats show-desc X X X X
2914stats show-legends X X X X
2915stats show-node X X X X
2916stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002917-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2918stick match - - X X
2919stick on - - X X
2920stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002921stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002922stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02002923tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02002924tcp-check connect X - X X
2925tcp-check expect X - X X
2926tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02002927tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02002928tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02002929tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02002930tcp-check set-var X - X X
2931tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002932tcp-request connection - X X -
2933tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002934tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002935tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002936tcp-response content - - X X
2937tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002938timeout check X - X X
2939timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002940timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002941timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002942timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2943timeout http-request X X X X
2944timeout queue X - X X
2945timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002946timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002947timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002948timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002949transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002950unique-id-format X X X -
2951unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002952use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002953use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002954use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002955------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2956 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002957
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002958
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020029594.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2960---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002961
2962This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2963
2964
2965acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2966 Declare or complete an access list.
2967 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2968 no | yes | yes | yes
2969 Example:
2970 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2971 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2972 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2973
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002974 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002975
2976
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002977backlog <conns>
2978 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2979 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2980 yes | yes | yes | no
2981 Arguments :
2982 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2983 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002984 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002985
2986 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2987 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2988 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2989 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2990 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2991 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2992 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2993 backlog parameter.
2994
2995 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2996 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2997 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2998
2999 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3000
3001
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003002balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003003balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003004 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3005 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3006 yes | no | yes | yes
3007 Arguments :
3008 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3009 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3010 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3011 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3012
3013 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3014 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3015 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3016 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003017 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003018 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003019 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3020 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3021 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3022 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3023 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3024 it, so that you don't worry.
3025
3026 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3027 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3028 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3029 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3030 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3031 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3032 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3033 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003034
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003035 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3036 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3037 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3038 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3039 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3040 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3041 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
3042 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
3043
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003044 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003045 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003046 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3047 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003048 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003049 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3050 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3051 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3052 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3053 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003054 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3055 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3056 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3057 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3058 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3059 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003060
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003061 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3062 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3063 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3064 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3065 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3066 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3067 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3068 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003069 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003070 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003071 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3072 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3073 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003074
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003075 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3076 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3077 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3078 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3079 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3080 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3081 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3082 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3083 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3084 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3085 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3086 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003087
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003088 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003089 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3090 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3091 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3092 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3093 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3094 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3095 URIs start with a leading "/".
3096
3097 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3098 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3099 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3100 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3101
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003102 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003103 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3104
3105 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003106 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3107 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003108 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3109 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3110 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3111 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003112 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003113 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3114 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003115
3116 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3117 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3118 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3119 server will receive the request.
3120
3121 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3122 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3123 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3124 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3125 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003126 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3127 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3128 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003129
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003130 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3131 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3132 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3133 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3134 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003135
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003136 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003137 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3138 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3139 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3140
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003141 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3142 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3143 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3144
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003145 random
3146 random(<draws>)
3147 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003148 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3149 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3150 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3151 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003152 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3153 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3154 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3155 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3156 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3157 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3158 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3159 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3160 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3161 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3162 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3163 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3164 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3165 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3166 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3167 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3168 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3169 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3170 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3171 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003172
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003173 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003174 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003175 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3176 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3177 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3178 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3179 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3180 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003181 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003182 used instead.
3183
3184 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3185 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3186 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3187 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3188
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003189 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3190 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3191 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3192
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003193 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003194
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003195 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003196 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3197 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003198
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003199 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3200 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3201 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003202
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003203 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003204 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003205 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3206 NTLM relies on.
3207
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003208 Examples :
3209 balance roundrobin
3210 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003211 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003212 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3213 balance hdr(host)
3214 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003215
3216 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3217 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3218
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003219 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003220 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3221 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3222 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003223 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003224
3225 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3226 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3227 defaults to 16 kB.
3228
3229 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3230 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3231
3232 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3233 Round Robin.
3234
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003235 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003236 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3237 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3238 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3239
3240 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3241
3242 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003243 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003244 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3245 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3246 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003247
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003248 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003249
3250
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003251bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3252bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003253 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3255 no | yes | yes | no
3256 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003257 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3258 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3259 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3260 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003261 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003262 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3263 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3264 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3265 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3266 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3267 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
3268 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003269 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3270 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3271 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3272 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3273 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3274 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3275 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003276 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3277 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3278 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003279 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3280 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3281 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3282 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003283 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3284 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3285 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003286
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003287 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3288 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003289 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3290 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3291 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003292 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3293 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3294 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3295 the range.
3296
3297 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3298 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3299 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3300 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3301 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3302 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3303 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003304 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003305 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003306
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003307 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003308 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003309 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3310 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3311 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3312 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3313 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3314 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3315
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003316 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3317 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3318 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3319 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003320
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003321 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3322 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3323 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3324 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3325 in a frontend.
3326
3327 Example :
3328 listen http_proxy
3329 bind :80,:443
3330 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003331 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003332
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003333 listen http_https_proxy
3334 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003335 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003336
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003337 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3338 bind ipv6@:80
3339 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3340 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3341
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003342 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003343 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003344
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003345 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3346 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3347 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3348 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3349 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3350
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003351 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003352 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003353
3354
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003355bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003356 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3357 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3358 yes | yes | yes | yes
3359 Arguments :
3360 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3361 may be used to override a default value.
3362
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003363 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003364 option may be combined with other numbers.
3365
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003366 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003367 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3368 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3369 missing from all processes.
3370
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003371 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003372 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003373 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3374 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3375 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3376 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3377 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003378 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003379
3380 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3381 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3382 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3383 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3384 and 'even' instances.
3385
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003386 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3387 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3388 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3389 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003390
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003391 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3392 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3393
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003394 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3395 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3396 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3397
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003398 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3399 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3400
3401 Example :
3402 listen app_ip1
3403 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003404 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003405
3406 listen app_ip2
3407 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003408 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003409
3410 listen management
3411 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003412 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003413
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003414 listen management
3415 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3416 bind-process 1-4
3417
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003418 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003419
3420
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003421capture cookie <name> len <length>
3422 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3423 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3424 no | yes | yes | no
3425 Arguments :
3426 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3427 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3428 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3429 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003430 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003431
3432 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3433 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3434 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3435 right if it exceeds <length>.
3436
3437 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3438 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3439 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3440 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3441
3442 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3443 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3444 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3445
3446 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3447 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3448 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003449 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3450 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3451 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003452
3453 Example:
3454 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3455
3456 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003457 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003458
3459
3460capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003461 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003462 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3463 no | yes | yes | no
3464 Arguments :
3465 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003466 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003467 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3468 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3469 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3470
3471 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3472 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3473 it exceeds <length>.
3474
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003475 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003476 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3477 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003478 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3479 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3480 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3481 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003482 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003483 environments to find where the request came from.
3484
3485 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3486 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3487 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3488 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003489
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003490 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3491 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3492 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3493 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3494 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003495
3496 Example:
3497 capture request header Host len 15
3498 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003499 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003500
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003501 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003502 about logging.
3503
3504
3505capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003506 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3508 no | yes | yes | no
3509 Arguments :
3510 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003511 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003512 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3513 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3514 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3515
3516 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3517 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3518 it exceeds <length>.
3519
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003520 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003521 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3522 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3523 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003524 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3525 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3526 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3527 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003528
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003529 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3530 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3531 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3532 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3533 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003534
3535 Example:
3536 capture response header Content-length len 9
3537 capture response header Location len 15
3538
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003539 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003540 about logging.
3541
3542
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003543compression algo <algorithm> ...
3544compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003545compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003546 Enable HTTP compression.
3547 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3548 yes | yes | yes | yes
3549 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003550 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3551 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3552 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3553
3554 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003555 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3556 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3557 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003558
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003559 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003560 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003561
3562 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3563 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3564 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3565 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3566 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003567 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003568
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003569 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3570 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3571 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3572 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3573 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3574 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3575 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003576 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003577
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003578 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003579 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003580 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3581 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3582 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3583 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3584 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003585
3586 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3587 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3588 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3589 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3590 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003591 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3592 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3593 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3594 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3595 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003596 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3597 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003598
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003599 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003600 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3601 "Accept-Encoding" header
3602 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003603 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003604 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3605 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3606 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3607 "multipart"
3608 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3609 header
3610 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3611 and later
3612 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3613 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003614 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003615
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003616 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003617
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003618 Examples :
3619 compression algo gzip
3620 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003621
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003622
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003623cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003624 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3625 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003626 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003627 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3628 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3629 yes | no | yes | yes
3630 Arguments :
3631 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3632 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3633 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3634 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3635 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3636 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003637 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003638 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3639 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3640
3641 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3642 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3643 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3644 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3645 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3646 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003647 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3648 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003649 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003650 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3651 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003652
3653 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003654 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003655
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003656 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003657 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003658 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003659 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003660 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3661 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3662 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3663 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3664 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3665 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3666 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003667
3668 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3669 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3670 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3671 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3672 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3673 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3674 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3675 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3676 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003677 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003678 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3679 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3680 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003681
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003682 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3683 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3684 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003685 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3686 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3687 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3688 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003689 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3690 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3691 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003692
3693 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3694 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3695 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3696 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3697 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3698 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3699 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3700 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3701 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3702
3703 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3704 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3705 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3706 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3707 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3708 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3709 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3710 persistence cookie in the cache.
3711 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3712
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003713 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3714 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3715 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3716 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3717 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003718 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003719 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3720 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3721 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3722 they logout.
3723
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003724 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3725 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3726 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3727 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3728
3729 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3730 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3731 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3732 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3733 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3734 this attribute.
3735
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003736 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003737 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003738 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3739 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3740 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3741 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3742 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3743 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003744
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003745 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3746 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3747 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3748 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3749 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3750 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3751 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3752 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003753 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003754 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3755 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3756 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3757 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3758 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3759 the site.
3760
3761 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3762 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3763 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3764 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3765 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3766 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3767 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3768 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3769 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3770 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3771 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3772 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3773 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003774 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003775 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3776 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3777
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003778 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3779 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3780 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3781 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3782 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3783 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3784
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003785 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
3786 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
3787 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
3788 repeated.
3789
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003790 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3791 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3792 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3793 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003794
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003795 Examples :
3796 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3797 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3798 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003799 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003800
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003801 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003802
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003803
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003804declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3805 Declares a capture slot.
3806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3807 no | yes | yes | no
3808 Arguments:
3809 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3810
3811 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3812 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3813 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3814 for use in the response.
3815
3816 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003817 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003818 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3819
3820
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003821default-server [param*]
3822 Change default options for a server in a backend
3823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3824 yes | no | yes | yes
3825 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003826 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3827 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3828 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3829 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003830
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003831 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003832 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3833
3834 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003835
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003836
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003837default_backend <backend>
3838 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3839 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3840 yes | yes | yes | no
3841 Arguments :
3842 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3843
3844 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3845 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3846 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3847 will catch all undetermined requests.
3848
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003849 Example :
3850
3851 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3852 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3853 default_backend dynamic
3854
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003855 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003856
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003857
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003858description <string>
3859 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3860 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3861 no | yes | yes | yes
3862 Arguments : string
3863
3864 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3865 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3866 it describes.
3867 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3868
3869
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003870disabled
3871 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3872 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3873 yes | yes | yes | yes
3874 Arguments : none
3875
3876 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3877 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3878 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3879 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3880 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3881 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3882 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3883
3884 See also : "enabled"
3885
3886
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003887dispatch <address>:<port>
3888 Set a default server address
3889 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3890 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003891 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003892
3893 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3894 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3895 during start-up.
3896
3897 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3898 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3899 possible with normal servers.
3900
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003901 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003902 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3903 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3904 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3905 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3906
3907 See also : "server"
3908
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003909
3910dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3911 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3912 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3913 yes | no | yes | yes
3914 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3915
3916 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003917 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003918 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3919 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003920 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003921 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003922
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003923enabled
3924 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3925 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3926 yes | yes | yes | yes
3927 Arguments : none
3928
3929 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3930 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3931
3932 See also : "disabled"
3933
3934
3935errorfile <code> <file>
3936 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3937 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3938 yes | yes | yes | yes
3939 Arguments :
3940 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003941 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02003942 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003943
3944 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003945 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003946 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003947 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3948 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003949
3950 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3951 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3952 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3953
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003954 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3955
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02003956 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
3957 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
3958 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
3959 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
3960 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
3961 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
3962 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
3963 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
3964 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003965
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003966 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3967 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3968 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003969 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003970 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3971
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003972 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003973
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003974 Example :
3975 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003976 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003977 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3978 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3979
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003980
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003981errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
3982 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
3983 section.
3984 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3985 yes | yes | yes | yes
3986 Arguments :
3987 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
3988
3989 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003990 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02003991 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003992
3993 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
3994 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
3995 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
3996 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
3997 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
3998 ones. Fonctionnly, it is exactly the same than declaring all error files by
3999 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4000
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004001 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4002 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004003
4004 Example :
4005 errorfiles generic
4006 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4007
4008
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004009errorloc <code> <url>
4010errorloc302 <code> <url>
4011 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4013 yes | yes | yes | yes
4014 Arguments :
4015 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004016 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004017 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004018
4019 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4020 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4021 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4022 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004023 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004024
4025 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4026 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4027 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4028
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004029 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4030
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004031 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4032 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4033 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4034 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004035 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004036 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4037 request.
4038
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004039 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004040
4041
4042errorloc303 <code> <url>
4043 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4044 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4045 yes | yes | yes | yes
4046 Arguments :
4047 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004048 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004049 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004050
4051 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4052 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4053 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4054 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004055 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004056
4057 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4058 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4059 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4060
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004061 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4062
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004063 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4064 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4065 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4066 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004067 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004068
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004069 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004070
4071
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004072email-alert from <emailaddr>
4073 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004074 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004075 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4076 yes | yes | yes | yes
4077
4078 Arguments :
4079
4080 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4081
4082 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4083 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4084
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004085 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004086 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4087 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004088
4089
4090email-alert level <level>
4091 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4092 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4093 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4094 yes | yes | yes | yes
4095
4096 Arguments :
4097
4098 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4099 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4100 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4101
4102 By default level is alert
4103
4104 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4105 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4106 for the proxy.
4107
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004108 Alerts are sent when :
4109
4110 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4111 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4112 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4113 is notice or lower
4114 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4115 and a health check status update occurs
4116
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004117 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4118 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004119 section 3.6 about mailers.
4120
4121
4122email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4123 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4124 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4125 yes | yes | yes | yes
4126
4127 Arguments :
4128
4129 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4130
4131 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4132 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4133
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004134 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4135 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004136
4137
4138email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4139 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4140 mailers.
4141 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4142 yes | yes | yes | yes
4143
4144 Arguments :
4145
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004146 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004147
4148 By default the systems hostname is used.
4149
4150 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4151 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4152 for the proxy.
4153
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004154 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4155 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004156
4157
4158email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004159 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004160 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4161 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4162 yes | yes | yes | yes
4163
4164 Arguments :
4165
4166 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4167
4168 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4169 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4170
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004171 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004172 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4173
4174
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004175force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4176 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4177 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004178 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004179
4180 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4181 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4182 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4183 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4184 marked down for maintenance operations.
4185
4186 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4187 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4188 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4189 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4190 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4191 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4192 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4193 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4194 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4195
4196 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4197 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4198 is used.
4199
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004200 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004201 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004202
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004203
4204filter <name> [param*]
4205 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4207 no | yes | yes | yes
4208 Arguments :
4209 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4210 referenced in section 9.
4211
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004212 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004213 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004214 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4215 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004216
4217 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4218 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4219
4220 Example:
4221 listen
4222 bind *:80
4223
4224 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4225 filter compression
4226 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4227
4228 compression algo gzip
4229 compression offload
4230
4231 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4232
4233 See also : section 9.
4234
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004235
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004236fullconn <conns>
4237 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4239 yes | no | yes | yes
4240 Arguments :
4241 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4242 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4243
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004244 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004245 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004246 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004247 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4248 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4249 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4250 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4251 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004252 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004253
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004254 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4255 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004256 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4257 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4258 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004259
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004260 Example :
4261 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4262 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4263 # connections.
4264 backend dynamic
4265 fullconn 10000
4266 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4267 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4268
4269 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4270
4271
4272grace <time>
4273 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4274 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004275 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004276 Arguments :
4277 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4278 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4279 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4280
4281 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4282 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004283 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004284 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4285
4286 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4287 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4288 simplify it.
4289
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004290
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004291hash-balance-factor <factor>
4292 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4293 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4294 yes | no | no | yes
4295 Arguments :
4296 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4297 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004298 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004299
4300 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4301 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4302 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4303 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4304 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4305 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4306 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4307
4308 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4309 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4310 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4311 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4312 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4313
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004314 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4315 consistent hashing mechanism.
4316
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004317 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4318
4319
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004320hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004321 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4322 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4323 yes | no | yes | yes
4324 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004325 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4326 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004327
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004328 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4329 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4330 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4331 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4332 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4333 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4334 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4335 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4336 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4337 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004338
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004339 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4340 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4341 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4342 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4343 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4344 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4345 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4346 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4347 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4348 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4349 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4350 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4351 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004352 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4353 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004354
4355 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4356
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004357 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004358 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4359 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4360 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004361 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4362 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4363 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004364
4365 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4366 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004367 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4368 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4369 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4370 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4371
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004372 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4373 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4374 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4375 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4376 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4377 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4378 parameter.
4379
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004380 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4381 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4382 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4383 used on strings.
4384
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004385 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4386
4387 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4388 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4389 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4390 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4391 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4392 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4393 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4394 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4395 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4396 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4397 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4398 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004399
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004400 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4401 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4402 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004403
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004404 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004405
4406
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004407http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4408 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4409 ones).
4410
4411 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4412 no | yes | yes | yes
4413
4414 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4415 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4416 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4417 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4418 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4419 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4420
4421 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4422 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4423 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4424
4425 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4426 below.
4427
4428 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4429 instance.
4430
4431 Example:
4432 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4433 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4434 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4435
4436http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4437
4438 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4439 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4440 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4441 example, or to pass some internal information.
4442 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4443 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4444 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4445
4446http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4447
4448 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4449 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4450
4451http-after-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4452
4453 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
4454
4455http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4456 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4457
4458 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4459
4460 Example:
4461 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4462
4463 # applied to:
4464 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4465
4466 # outputs:
4467 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4468
4469 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4470
4471http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4472 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4473
4474 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4475
4476 Example:
4477 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4478
4479 # applied to:
4480 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4481
4482 # outputs:
4483 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4484
4485http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4486
4487 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4488 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4489 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
4490
4491http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4492 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4493
4494 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4495 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4496 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4497 fallback.
4498
4499 Example:
4500 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4501 http-response set-status 431
4502 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4503 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
4504
4505http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4506
4507 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4508 inline.
4509
4510 Arguments:
4511 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4512 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4513 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4514 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4515 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4516 (request and response)
4517 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4518 processing
4519 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4520 processing
4521 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4522 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4523 and '_'.
4524
4525 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4526 followed by some converters.
4527
4528 Example:
4529 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4530
4531http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
4532
4533 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
4534 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
4535 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
4536 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
4537 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004538 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004539 processing.
4540
4541 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
4542 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
4543 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
4544 rules evaluation.
4545
4546http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4547
4548 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
4549 details about <var-name>.
4550
4551 Example:
4552 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4553
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004554
4555http-check comment <string>
4556 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
4557 it fails.
4558 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4559 yes | no | yes | yes
4560
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004561 Arguments :
4562 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
4563 rule fails.
4564
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004565 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
4566 user-friendly error reporting.
4567
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004568 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check conncet", "http-check send" and
4569 "http-check expect".
4570
4571
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004572http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
4573 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004574 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004575 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
4576 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4577 yes | no | yes | yes
4578
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004579 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004580 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4581
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004582 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
4583 checks. The server options are used only if not redifined.
4584
4585 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
4586 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
4587 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
4588 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
4589
4590 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
4591
4592 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
4593
4594 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
4595
4596 ssl opens a ciphered connection
4597
4598 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
4599
4600 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
4601 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
4602 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
4603 is used.
4604
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004605 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
4606 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
4607 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
4608 haproxy -vv.
4609
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004610 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
4611
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004612 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
4613 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
4614 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
4615 different ports or with different servers.
4616
4617 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
4618 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
4619 the port with a "http-check connect".
4620
4621 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
4622 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
4623 do.
4624
4625 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
4626 unset-var or comment rules.
4627
4628 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004629 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
4630 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
4631 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
4632 option httpchk
4633
4634 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02004635 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004636 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004637 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02004638 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004639 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004640
4641 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
4642
4643 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004644
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004645
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004646http-check disable-on-404
4647 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4648 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004649 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004650 Arguments : none
4651
4652 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4653 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4654 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4655 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4656 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4657 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4658 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4659 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004660 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4661 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4662 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4663
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004664 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004665
4666
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004667http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004668 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
4669 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
4670 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004671 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004673 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004674
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004675 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004676 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4677
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004678 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
4679 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
4680 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
4681 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
4682 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
4683 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
4684 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
4685 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
4686 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
4687 result is always conclusive.
4688
4689 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4690 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
4691 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004692 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
4693 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
4694 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
4695 example 404 with disable-on-404
4696 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
4697 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
4698 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004699
4700 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4701 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004702 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
4703 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
4704 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
4705 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
4706 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
4707 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004708
4709 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4710 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004711 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
4712 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
4713 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
4714 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004715 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
4716
4717 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4718 informational message reported in logs if the expect
4719 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
4720 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
4721
4722 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4723 informational message reported in logs if an error
4724 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
4725 log-format string.
4726
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004727 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004728 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
4729 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004730 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4731 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4732 details on the supported keywords.
4733
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004734 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
4735 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
4736 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
4737 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004738
4739 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4740 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4741 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4742 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4743 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4744
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004745 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
4746 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
4747 codes. A health check response will be considered as
4748 valid if the response's status code matches any status
4749 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
4750 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4751 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004752
4753 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004754 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004755 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4756 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4757 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4758 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4759
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004760 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
4761 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004762 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
4763 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
4764 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
4765 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
4766 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
4767 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
4768 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
4769 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004770 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
4771 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
4772 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
4773 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
4774 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
4775 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
4776 insensitive on the header names.
4777
4778 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
4779 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
4780 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
4781 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
4782 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
4783 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004784
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004785 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004786 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004787 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4788 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4789 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4790 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4791 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004792 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004793 trace).
4794
4795 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004796 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004797 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4798 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4799 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4800 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4801 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004802 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004803
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02004804 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
4805 A health check response will be considered valid if the
4806 response's body contains the string resulting of the
4807 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
4808 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4809 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
4810
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004811 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4812 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4813 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4814 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4815 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4816 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4817 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4818 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4819
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004820 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
4821 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
4822 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
4823 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
4824 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004825
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004826 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4827 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4828
4829 Examples :
4830 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004831 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004832
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004833 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
4834 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
4835
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004836 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004837 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004838
4839 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004840 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004841
4842 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004843 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004844
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004845 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004846 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004847
4848
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02004849http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02004850 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
4851 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004852 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
4853 health checks.
4854 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4855 yes | no | yes | yes
4856 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004857 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4858
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004859 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
4860 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
4861 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
4862 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
4863 to invent non-standard ones.
4864
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02004865 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
4866 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
4867 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
4868 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4869
4870 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
4871 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
4872 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4873 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004874
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02004875 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004876 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
4877 1.0, so turningit to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
4878 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
4879 to add it.
4880
4881 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4882 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
4883 to the log-format rules.
4884
4885 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
4886 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
4887 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004888
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02004889 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
4890 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
4891 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
4892 request.
4893
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004894 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
4895 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
4896 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02004897 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
4898 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
4899 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
4900 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004901 deprecated. Note also the "Connection: close" header is still added if a
4902 "http-check expect" direcive is defined independently of this directive, just
4903 like the state header if the directive "http-check send-state" is defined.
4904
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004905 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4906 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02004907 header should not be present in the request provided by "http-check send". If
4908 so, it will be ignored.
4909
4910 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
4911 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
4912 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
4913 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
4914 configured request authority.
4915
4916 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
4917 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004918
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004919 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004920
4921
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004922http-check send-state
4923 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4924 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4925 yes | no | yes | yes
4926 Arguments : none
4927
4928 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4929 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4930 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4931 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4932 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4933
4934 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4935 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4936 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4937 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4938 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004939 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4940 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4941 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4942
4943 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4944 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4945 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4946
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004947 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4948 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4949 checked in multiple backends.
4950
4951 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4952 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4953
4954 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4955 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4956 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4957 one fails.
4958
4959 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4960 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4961 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4962
4963 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4964 server's queue.
4965
4966 Example of a header received by the application server :
4967 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4968 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4969
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004970 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
4971 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004972
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004973
4974http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004975 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004976 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4977 yes | no | yes | yes
4978
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004979 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004980 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4981 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
4982 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
4983 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
4984 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
4985 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4986 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
4987 and '-'.
4988
4989 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
4990
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004991 Examples :
4992 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004993
4994
4995http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004996 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004997 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4998 yes | no | yes | yes
4999
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005000 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005001 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5002 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5003 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5004 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5005 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5006 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5007 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5008 and '-'.
5009
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005010 Examples :
5011 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005012
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005013
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005014http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5015 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5016 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5017 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5018 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5019 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5020 yes | yes | yes | yes
5021 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005022 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005023 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005024 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
5025 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005026
5027 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5028 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5029 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5030 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5031
5032 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5033 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5034 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5035 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5036
5037 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5038 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5039 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5040 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5041 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5042 chroot is performed.
5043
5044 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5045 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5046 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5047 considered.
5048
5049 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5050 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5051 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5052 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5053 considered as a raw string.
5054
5055 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5056 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5057 "content-type".
5058
5059 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5060 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5061 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5062 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5063 evaluated as a log-format string.
5064
5065 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5066 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5067 argument to "content-type".
5068
5069 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5070 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5071 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5072 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5073
5074 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5075 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5076 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5077 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5078 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5079 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5080 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5081 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5082
5083 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5084 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5085 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5086
5087 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5088 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5089
5090
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005091http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005092 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5093
5094 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5095 no | yes | yes | yes
5096
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005097 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5098 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5099 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5100 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5101 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005102
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005103 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5104 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005105
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005106 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005107
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005108 Example:
5109 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5110 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5111 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005112
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005113 http-request allow if nagios
5114 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5115 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5116 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005117
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005118 Example:
5119 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5120 acl add path /addacl
5121 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005122
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005123 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005124
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005125 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5126 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005127
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005128 Example:
5129 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5130 acl setmap path /setmap
5131 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005132
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005133 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005134
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005135 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5136 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005137
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005138 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5139 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005140
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005141http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005142
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005143 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5144 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5145 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5146 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5147 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5148 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5149 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5150 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005151
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005152http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005153
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005154 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5155 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5156 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5157 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5158 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5159 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5160 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5161 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005162
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005163http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005164
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005165 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5166 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005167
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005168
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005169http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005170
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005171 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5172 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5173 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5174 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5175 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005176
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005177 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5178 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5179 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5180 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5181 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5182 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5183 instead.
5184
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005185 Example:
5186 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5187 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005188
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005189http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005190
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005191 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005192
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005193http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5194 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005195
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005196 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5197 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5198 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5199 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5200 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5201 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5202 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5203 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5204 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005205
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005206 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5207 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5208 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005209 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5210
5211 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5212 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5213 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5214 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005215
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005216http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005217
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005218 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5219 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5220 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5221 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5222 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5223 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005224
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005225http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005226
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005227 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005228
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005229http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005230
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005231 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5232 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5233 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5234 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5235 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5236 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005237
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005238http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5239http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5240 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5241 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5242 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5243 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005244
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005245 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
5246 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
5247 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005248 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005249 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5250 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5251 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005252 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005253 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005254
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02005255http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5256 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
5257 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
5258 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
5259
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01005260http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
5261
5262 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
5263 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
5264 pointed by <resolvers>.
5265 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
5266 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
5267 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
5268 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
5269 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
5270 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
5271 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
5272 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
5273 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
5274 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
5275 to 0.0.0.0.
5276
5277 Example:
5278 resolvers mydns
5279 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
5280 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
5281 timeout retry 1s
5282 hold valid 10s
5283 hold nx 3s
5284 hold other 3s
5285 hold obsolete 0s
5286 accepted_payload_size 8192
5287
5288 frontend fe
5289 bind 10.42.0.1:80
5290 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
5291 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
5292
5293 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
5294 # which mean DNS resolution error
5295 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
5296
5297 default_backend be
5298
5299 backend b_503
5300 # dummy backend used to return 503.
5301 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
5302 # 503 error page to end users
5303
5304 backend be
5305 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
5306 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
5307 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
5308 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
5309 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
5310
5311 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
5312 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
5313
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005314http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5315
5316 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
5317 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
5318 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
5319 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01005320 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
5321 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005322
5323 See RFC 8297 for more information.
5324
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005325http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005326
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005327 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
5328 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
5329 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
5330 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
5331 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005332
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005333http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005334
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005335 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
5336 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
5337 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
5338 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005339
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005340http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5341 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02005342
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005343 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005344 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
5345 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
5346 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
5347 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
5348 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02005349
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005350 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
5351 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
5352 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
5353 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
5354 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005355
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005356 Example:
5357 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
5358
5359 # applied to:
5360 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5361
5362 # outputs:
5363 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5364
5365 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005366
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005367 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
5368
5369 # applied to:
5370 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005371
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005372 # outputs:
5373 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005374
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005375http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5376 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5377
5378 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
5379 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
5380 after an optional scheme+authority. It does contain the query string if any
5381 is present. The replacement does not modify the scheme nor authority.
5382
5383 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5384 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5385 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
5386
5387 Example:
5388 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5389 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
5390
5391 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
5392 http-request replace-path ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
5393
5394 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
5395 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
5396 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
5397 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
5398
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005399http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5400 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5401
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005402 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
5403 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
5404 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
5405 against.
5406
5407 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5408 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5409 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005410
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005411 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
5412 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
5413 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
5414 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
5415 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
5416 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
5417 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
5418 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
5419 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005420 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
5421 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005422
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005423 Example:
5424 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
5425 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005426
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005427 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5428 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005429
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005430http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5431 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005432
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005433 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
5434 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
5435 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
5436 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005437
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005438 Example:
5439 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005440
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005441 # applied to:
5442 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005443
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005444 # outputs:
5445 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005446
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005447http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5448 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5449 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005450 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005451 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5452
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005453 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005454 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5455 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
5456 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itselft may
5457 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005458 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005459 are followed to create the response :
5460
5461 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5462 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5463 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5464 ignored.
5465
5466 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5467 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005468 status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
5469 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
5470 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005471
5472 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5473 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5474 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005475 by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
5476 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005477
5478 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5479 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5480 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
5481 must be one of the status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005482 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
5483 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005484
5485 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5486 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5487 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5488 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5489 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5490 as a raw content.
5491
5492 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5493 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5494 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5495 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5496 considered as a raw string.
5497
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005498 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
5499 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5500 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5501 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5502
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005503 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5504 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005505 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005506
5507 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5508
5509 Example:
5510 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproy/errorfiles/200.http \
5511 if { path /ping }
5512
5513 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
5514 if { path /favicon.ico }
5515
5516 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
5517 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
5518 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
5519
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005520http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5521http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005522
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005523 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5524 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5525 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005526
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005527http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5528 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005529
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005530 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5531 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5532 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5533 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005534
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005535http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005536
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005537 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
5538 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
5539 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
5540 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
5541 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005542
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005543 Arguments:
5544 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5545 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005546
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005547 Example:
5548 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
5549 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005550
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005551 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
5552 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005553
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005554http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005555
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005556 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
5557 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
5558 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005559
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005560 Arguments:
5561 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5562 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005563
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005564 Example:
5565 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
5566 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005567
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005568 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
5569 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
5570 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005571
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005572http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005573
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005574 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
5575 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
5576 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
5577 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
5578 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005579
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005580 Example:
5581 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
5582 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
5583 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
5584 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
5585 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
5586 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
5587 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
5588 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
5589 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005590
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005591http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005592
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005593 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5594 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5595 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5596 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
5597 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005598
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005599http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5600 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005601
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005602 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5603 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5604 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5605 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5606 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
5607 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
5608 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
5609 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
5610 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005611
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005612http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005613
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005614 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5615 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5616 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5617 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
5618 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
5619 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
5620 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005621
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005622http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005623
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005624 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
5625 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
5626 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005627
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005628http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005629
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005630 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
5631 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
5632 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
5633 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
5634 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
5635 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5636 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5637 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005638
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005639http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005640
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005641 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
5642 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
5643 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
5644 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
5645 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
5646 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005647
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005648 Example :
5649 # prepend the host name before the path
5650 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005651
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005652http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02005653
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005654 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
5655 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
5656 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5657 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
5658 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005659
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005660http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005661
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005662 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
5663 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
5664 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5665 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
5666 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
5667 values have higher priority.
5668 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
5669 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
5670 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
5671 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
5672 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005673
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005674http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005675
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005676 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
5677 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
5678 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
5679 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
5680 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
5681 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
5682 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005683
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005684 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005685
5686 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005687 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
5688 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005689
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005690http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5691 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
5692 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
5693 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005694 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
5695 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005696
5697 Arguments :
5698 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5699 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005700
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005701 See also "option forwardfor".
5702
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005703 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005704 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
5705 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
5706
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005707 # After the masking this will track connections
5708 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
5709 http-request track-sc0 src
5710
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005711 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
5712 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
5713
5714http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5715
5716 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
5717 expression.
5718
5719 Arguments:
5720 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5721 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005722
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005723 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005724 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
5725 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
5726
5727 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
5728 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
5729 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
5730
5731http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5732
5733 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5734 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
5735 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
5736 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
5737 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
5738 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
5739 information from the request.
5740
5741 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5742
5743http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5744
5745 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
5746 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
5747 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
5748 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
5749 path and the query string.
5750 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
5751
5752http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5753
5754 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5755 inline.
5756
5757 Arguments:
5758 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5759 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5760 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5761 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5762 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5763 (request and response)
5764 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5765 processing
5766 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5767 processing
5768 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5769 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
5770 and '_'.
5771
5772 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5773 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005774
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005775 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005776 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005777
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005778http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
5779 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005780
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005781 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5782 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5783 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5784 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5785 agent name must be used.
5786
5787 Arguments:
5788 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
5789
5790 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5791 configuration.
5792
5793http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5794
5795 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5796 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5797 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5798 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5799 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5800 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5801 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5802 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5803 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5804 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5805 action.
5806 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5807 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5808 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5809 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5810 you fully understand how it works.
5811
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005812http-request strict-mode { on | off }
5813
5814 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5815 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5816 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5817 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5818 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005819 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005820 processing.
5821
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005822 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005823 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5824 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
5825 rules evaluation.
5826
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005827http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5828http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5829 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5830 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5831 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5832 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005833
5834 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
5835 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
5836 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005837 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
5838 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
5839 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
5840 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
5841 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
5842 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
5843 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
5844 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
5845 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
5846 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005847 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005848 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5849 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5850 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
5851 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5852 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005853
5854http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5855http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5856http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5857
5858 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
5859 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
5860 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
5861 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
5862 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
5863 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5864 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
5865 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
5866 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5867 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
5868 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
5869 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
5870
5871 Arguments :
5872 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
5873 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
5874 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
5875 select which table entry to update the counters.
5876
5877 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
5878 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
5879 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
5880 that table until the session ends.
5881
5882 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
5883 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
5884 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
5885 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
5886 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
5887 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
5888 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
5889 useful information.
5890
5891 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
5892 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
5893 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
5894 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
5895 checks that make use of it.
5896
5897http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5898
5899 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005900
5901 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005902 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005903
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01005904http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5905
5906 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
5907 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
5908 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
5909 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
5910 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
5911 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5912
5913 Arguments :
5914 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
5915
5916 Example:
5917 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
5918
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005919http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005920
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005921 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
5922 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
5923 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005924
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005925
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005926http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005927 Access control for Layer 7 responses
5928
5929 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5930 no | yes | yes | yes
5931
5932 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5933 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5934 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5935 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5936 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5937 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5938
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005939 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5940 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005941
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005942 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005943
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005944 Example:
5945 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005946
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005947 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005948
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005949 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
5950 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005951
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005952 Example:
5953 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005954
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005955 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005956
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005957 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
5958 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005959
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005960 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5961 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005962
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005963http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005964
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005965 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5966 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5967 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5968 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5969 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5970 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5971 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5972 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005973
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005974http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005975
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005976 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5977 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5978 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5979 example, or to pass some internal information.
5980 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5981 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5982 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005983
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005984http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005985
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005986 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5987 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005988
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005989http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005990
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005991 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005992
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005993http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005994
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005995 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5996 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
5997 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
5998 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
5999 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
6000 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
6001 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006002
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006003 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
6004 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
6005 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
6006 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
6007 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006008
6009 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6010 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6011 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6012 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006013
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006014http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006015
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006016 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6017 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6018 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6019 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6020 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6021 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006022
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006023http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006024
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006025 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006026
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006027http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006028
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006029 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6030 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6031 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6032 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6033 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6034 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006035
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006036http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6037http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6038 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6039 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6040 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6041 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006042
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006043 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
6044 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6045 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006046 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006047 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
6048 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
6049 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01006050 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006051 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006052
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006053http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006054
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006055 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
6056 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
6057 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
6058 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
6059 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
6060 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006061
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006062http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6063 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006064
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006065 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
6066 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006067
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006068 Example:
6069 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02006070
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006071 # applied to:
6072 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006073
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006074 # outputs:
6075 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006076
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006077 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006078
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006079http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6080 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006081
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01006082 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006083 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006084
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006085 Example:
6086 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006087
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006088 # applied to:
6089 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006090
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006091 # outputs:
6092 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006093
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006094http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6095 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6096 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006097 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006098 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6099
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006100 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006101 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6102 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
6103 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itselft may
6104 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006105 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006106 are followed to create the response :
6107
6108 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6109 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6110 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6111 ignored.
6112
6113 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6114 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006115 status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
6116 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
6117 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006118
6119 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6120 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6121 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006122 by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
6123 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006124
6125 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6126 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6127 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
6128 must be one of the status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006129 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
6130 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006131
6132 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6133 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6134 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6135 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6136 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6137 as a raw content.
6138
6139 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6140 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6141 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6142 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6143 considered as a raw string.
6144
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006145 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
6146 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6147 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6148 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6149
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006150 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6151 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006152 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006153
6154 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
6155
6156 Example:
6157 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproy/errorfiles/200.http \
6158 if { status eq 404 }
6159
6160 http-response return content-type text/plain \
6161 string "This is the end !" \
6162 if { status eq 500 }
6163
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006164http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6165http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08006166
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006167 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6168 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6169 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006170
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006171http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6172 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006173
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006174 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6175 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6176 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6177 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006178
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006179http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006180
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006181 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6182 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6183 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6184 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6185 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006186
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006187 Arguments:
6188 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006189
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006190 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6191 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006192
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006193http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006194
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006195 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
6196 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
6197 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006198
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006199http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6200
6201 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6202 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6203 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6204 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
6205 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
6206
6207http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6208
6209 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6210 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6211 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6212 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6213 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
6214 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6215 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6216 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
6217 be triggered by an HTTP response.
6218
6219http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6220
6221 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6222 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6223 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6224 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
6225 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
6226 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
6227 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
6228
6229http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6230
6231 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
6232 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
6233 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
6234 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
6235 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
6236 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6237 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6238 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
6239
6240http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
6241 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6242
6243 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
6244 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
6245 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
6246 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006247
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006248 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006249 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
6250 http-response set-status 431
6251 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
6252 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006253
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006254http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006255
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006256 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6257 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
6258 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
6259 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
6260 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
6261 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
6262 based on some information from the request.
6263
6264 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6265
6266http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6267
6268 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6269 inline.
6270
6271 Arguments:
6272 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6273 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6274 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6275 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6276 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6277 (request and response)
6278 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6279 processing
6280 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6281 processing
6282 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6283 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
6284 and '_'.
6285
6286 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6287 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006288
6289 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006290 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006291
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006292http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006293
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006294 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6295 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6296 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6297 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6298 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6299 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6300 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6301 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6302 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6303 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6304 action.
6305 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6306 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6307 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6308 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6309 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006310
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006311http-response strict-mode { on | off }
6312
6313 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6314 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6315 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6316 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6317 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006318 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006319 processing.
6320
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006321 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006322 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6323 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
6324 rules evaluation.
6325
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006326http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6327http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6328http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006329
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006330 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
6331 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
6332 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
6333 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
6334 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
6335 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
6336
6337http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6338
6339 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
6340 about <var-name>.
6341
6342 Example:
6343 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
6344
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02006345
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006346http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
6347 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
6348
6349 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6350 yes | no | yes | yes
6351
6352 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006353 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
6354 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
6355 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006356
6357 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
6358
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006359 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
6360 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
6361 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
6362 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
6363 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
6364 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
6365 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
6366 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
6367 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
6368 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006369
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006370 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
6371 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
6372 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
6373 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
6374 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
6375 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
6376 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
6377 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006378
6379 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
6380 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
6381 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
6382 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
6383 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
6384 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
6385 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
6386 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02006387 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006388 downsides of rare connection failures.
6389
6390 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
6391 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
6392 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
6393 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
6394 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
6395 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006396 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006397 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
6398 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
6399 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
6400 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
6401 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
6402
6403 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006404 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
6405 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
6406 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006407
6408 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006409 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006410
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02006411 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
6412 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006413
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01006414 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006415
6416 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
6417 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
6418 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
6419
6420 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
6421
6422
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006423http-send-name-header [<header>]
6424 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006425 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6426 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006427 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006428 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
6429
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02006430 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
6431 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
6432 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
6433 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
6434 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
6435 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
6436 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
6437 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
6438 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
6439 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
6440 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
6441 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
6442 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
6443 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
6444 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
6445 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006446
6447 See also : "server"
6448
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006449id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006450 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
6451 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6452 no | yes | yes | yes
6453 Arguments : none
6454
6455 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
6456 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
6457 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006458
6459
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006460ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
6461 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
6462 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01006463 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006464
6465 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
6466 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
6467 and running).
6468
6469 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
6470 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
6471 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006472 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006473 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
6474
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006475 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
6476 "unless" condition is met.
6477
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006478 Example:
6479 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
6480 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
6481 ignore-persist if url_static
6482
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006483 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
6484
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006485load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
6486 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
6487 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6488 yes | no | yes | yes
6489
6490 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
6491 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
6492 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006493 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006494 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
6495 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
6496 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
6497 over the stats socket and redirect output.
6498
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006499 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006500 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02006501 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006502
6503 Arguments:
6504 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
6505 named "server-state-file".
6506
6507 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
6508 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
6509 name is used as a file name.
6510
6511 none don't load any stat for this backend
6512
6513 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006514 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
6515 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
6516 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006517 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006518 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006519
6520 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
6521 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
6522
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006523 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006524
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006525 global
6526 stats socket /tmp/socket
6527 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006528
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006529 defaults
6530 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006531
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006532 backend bk
6533 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6534 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006535
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006536
6537 Then one can run :
6538
6539 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
6540
6541 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
6542
6543 1
6544 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6545 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6546 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6547
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006548 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006549
6550 global
6551 stats socket /tmp/socket
6552 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
6553
6554 defaults
6555 load-server-state-from-file local
6556
6557 backend bk
6558 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6559 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
6560
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006561
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006562 Then one can run :
6563
6564 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
6565
6566 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
6567
6568 1
6569 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6570 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6571 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6572
6573 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
6574 "show servers state"
6575
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006576
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006577log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006578log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
6579 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006580no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006581 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
6582 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6583 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006584
6585 Prefix :
6586 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
6587 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
6588 prefix does not allow arguments.
6589
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006590 Arguments :
6591 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
6592 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
6593 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
6594 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
6595 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
6596 parameter.
6597
6598 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
6599 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
6600
6601 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
6602 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6603 standard syslog port).
6604
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01006605 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
6606 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6607 standard syslog port).
6608
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006609 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
6610 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
6611 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006612 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006613
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006614 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
6615 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
6616 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
6617 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
6618 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
6619 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
6620 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
6621 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
6622 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
6623 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
6624 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
6625 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
6626 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
6627 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
6628 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
6629 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006630 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
6631 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006632
6633 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
6634 and "fd@2", see above.
6635
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02006636 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
6637 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
6638 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
6639 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
6640 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
6641 having the logs instantly available.
6642
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006643 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
6644 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006645
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006646 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
6647 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
6648 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
6649 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
6650 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
6651 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
6652 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
6653 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
6654 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
6655 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006656 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006657
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006658 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
6659 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
6660 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
6661 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
6662 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
6663
6664 <sample_size>
6665 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
6666 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
6667 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
6668 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
6669 (see also <ranges> parameter).
6670
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01006671 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
6672 one of the following :
6673
6674 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
6675 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
6676
6677 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
6678 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
6679
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006680 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
6681 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
6682 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
6683 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
6684 systemd logger consumes.
6685
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006686 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
6687 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
6688 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
6689 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
6690
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006691 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
6692
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006693 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
6694 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
6695 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
6696
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006697 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
6698 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
6699 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
6700 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006701
6702 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
6703 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
6704 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006705 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
6706 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
6707 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
6708 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
6709 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006710
6711 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
6712
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006713 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
6714 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
6715 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006716
6717 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
6718 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
6719 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
6720 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
6721
6722 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
6723 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006724
6725 Example :
6726 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006727 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
6728 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
6729 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006730 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
6731 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006732 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006733
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006734
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006735log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006736 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
6737 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6738 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006739
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006740 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
6741 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
6742 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
6743 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
6744 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006745
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006746 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
6747 "option httplog" directives.
6748
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02006749log-format-sd <string>
6750 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
6751 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6752 yes | yes | yes | no
6753
6754 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
6755 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
6756 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
6757 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
6758 which covers the log format string in depth.
6759
6760 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
6761 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
6762
6763 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
6764 log format to "rfc5424".
6765
6766 Example :
6767 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
6768
6769
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01006770log-tag <string>
6771 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
6772 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6773 yes | yes | yes | yes
6774
6775 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
6776 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
6777 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
6778 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
6779 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
6780 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
6781 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
6782 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
6783 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006784
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006785max-keep-alive-queue <value>
6786 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
6787 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6788 yes | no | yes | yes
6789
6790 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
6791 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
6792 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
6793 servers.
6794
6795 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
6796 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
6797 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
6798 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
6799 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006800 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006801 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
6802 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
6803 picking a different server.
6804
6805 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
6806 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
6807 even if they have to be queued.
6808
6809 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
6810 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
6811
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01006812max-session-srv-conns <nb>
6813 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
6814 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
6815 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006816
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006817maxconn <conns>
6818 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
6819 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6820 yes | yes | yes | no
6821 Arguments :
6822 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
6823 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
6824 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
6825 closes.
6826
6827 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
6828 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
6829 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
6830 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01006831 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
6832 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
6833 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
6834 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006835
6836 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
6837 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
6838 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
6839
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01006840 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
6841 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02006842
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006843 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
6844
6845
6846mode { tcp|http|health }
6847 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
6848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6849 yes | yes | yes | yes
6850 Arguments :
6851 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
6852 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
6853 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
6854 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
6855
6856 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
6857 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
6858 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
6859 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
6860 brings HAProxy most of its value.
6861
6862 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006863 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
6864 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
6865 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
6866 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
6867 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
6868 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
6869 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006870
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006871 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
6872 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
6873 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006874
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006875 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006876 defaults http_instances
6877 mode http
6878
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006879 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006880
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006881
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006882monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006883 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6885 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006886 Arguments :
6887 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
6888 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006889 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006890 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
6891 backend and its backup.
6892
6893 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
6894 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
6895 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
6896 servers in a list of backends.
6897
6898 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
6899 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
6900 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
6901 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
6902 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
6903 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
6904 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006905 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
6906 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006907
6908 Example:
6909 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006910 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006911 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
6912 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
6913 monitor-uri /site_alive
6914 monitor fail if site_dead
6915
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006916 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006917
6918
6919monitor-net <source>
6920 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
6921 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6922 yes | yes | yes | no
6923 Arguments :
6924 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
6925 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
6926 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
6927 followed by a mask.
6928
6929 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
6930 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006931 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006932 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
6933
6934 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
6935 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
6936 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
6937 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006938 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
6939 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
6940 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006941
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006942 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
6943 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
6944 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
6945 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
6946 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
6947 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006948
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01006949 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
6950 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006951
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006952 Example :
6953 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
6954 frontend www
6955 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
6956
6957 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
6958
6959
6960monitor-uri <uri>
6961 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
6962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6963 yes | yes | yes | no
6964 Arguments :
6965 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
6966 health status instead of forwarding the request.
6967
6968 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
6969 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
6970 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
6971 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
6972 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
6973 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
6974 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
6975 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
6976
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01006977 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006978 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
6979 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
6980 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
6981 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
6982 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
6983 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006984
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01006985 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
6986 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
6987 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
6988 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
6989
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006990 Example :
6991 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
6992 frontend www
6993 mode http
6994 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
6995
6996 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
6997
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006998
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006999option abortonclose
7000no option abortonclose
7001 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
7002 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7003 yes | no | yes | yes
7004 Arguments : none
7005
7006 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
7007 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
7008 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
7009 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007010 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007011 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
7012 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
7013 encountered while delivering the response.
7014
7015 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
7016 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
7017 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
7018 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
7019 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
7020 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007021 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007022 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007023 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007024 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
7025 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
7026 still not served and not pollute the servers.
7027
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007028 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
7029 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007030 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
7031 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
7032 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
7033 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
7034 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
7035 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007036 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007037
7038 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7039 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7040
7041 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
7042
7043
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007044option accept-invalid-http-request
7045no option accept-invalid-http-request
7046 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
7047 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7048 yes | yes | yes | no
7049 Arguments : none
7050
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007051 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007052 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007053 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007054 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7055 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7056 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7057 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7058 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007059 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
7060 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
7061 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
7062 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007063 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007064 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02007065 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
7066 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
7067 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007068
7069 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7070 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7071 been confirmed.
7072
7073 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7074 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007075 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
7076 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007077 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7078
7079 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7080 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7081
7082 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
7083 stats socket.
7084
7085
7086option accept-invalid-http-response
7087no option accept-invalid-http-response
7088 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
7089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7090 yes | no | yes | yes
7091 Arguments : none
7092
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007093 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007094 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007095 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007096 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7097 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7098 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7099 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7100 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007101 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
7102 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
7103 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007104
7105 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7106 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7107 been confirmed.
7108
7109 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7110 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
7111 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
7112 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7113
7114 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7115 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7116
7117 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
7118 stats socket.
7119
7120
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007121option allbackups
7122no option allbackups
7123 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
7124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7125 yes | no | yes | yes
7126 Arguments : none
7127
7128 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
7129 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
7130 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
7131 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
7132 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
7133 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
7134 order between the backup servers anymore.
7135
7136 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
7137 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
7138
7139 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7140 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7141
7142
7143option checkcache
7144no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08007145 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007146 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7147 yes | no | yes | yes
7148 Arguments : none
7149
7150 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
7151 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007152 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007153 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
7154 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007155 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007156
7157 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007158 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007159 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007160 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
7161 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007162 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007163 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01007164 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
7165 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007166 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01007167 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
7168 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007169 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007170 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
7171 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
7172 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
7173 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
7174 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
7175 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
7176 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
7177 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
7178 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
7179
7180 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007181 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
7182 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
7183 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
7184 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007185
7186 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
7187 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007188 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007189 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007190
7191 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7192 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7193
7194
7195option clitcpka
7196no option clitcpka
7197 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
7198 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7199 yes | yes | yes | no
7200 Arguments : none
7201
7202 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7203 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007204 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007205 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7206
7207 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7208 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7209 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7210 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7211
7212 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7213 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7214 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7215 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7216 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7217
7218 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7219
7220 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7221 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7222 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
7223
7224 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7225 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7226
7227 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
7228
7229
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007230option contstats
7231 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
7232 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7233 yes | yes | yes | no
7234 Arguments : none
7235
7236 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
7237 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
7238 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
7239 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01007240 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
7241 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
7242 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
7243 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
7244 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007245
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02007246option disable-h2-upgrade
7247no option disable-h2-upgrade
7248 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
7249 connection.
7250 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7251 yes | yes | yes | no
7252 Arguments : none
7253
7254 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
7255 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
7256 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
7257 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
7258 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be used to
7259 disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only supported
7260 for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to force the
7261 HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind line.
7262
7263 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7264 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007265
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007266option dontlog-normal
7267no option dontlog-normal
7268 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
7269 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7270 yes | yes | yes | no
7271 Arguments : none
7272
7273 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
7274 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
7275 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
7276 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
7277 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
7278 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
7279 logged.
7280
7281 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
7282 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
7283 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
7284
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007285 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007286 logging.
7287
7288
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007289option dontlognull
7290no option dontlognull
7291 Enable or disable logging of null connections
7292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7293 yes | yes | yes | no
7294 Arguments : none
7295
7296 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
7297 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
7298 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
7299 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
7300 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
7301 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007302 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
7303 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
7304 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007305
7306 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007307 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007308 would not be logged.
7309
7310 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7311 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7312
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007313 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
7314 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007315
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007316
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007317option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007318 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
7319 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7320 yes | yes | yes | yes
7321 Arguments :
7322 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7323 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007324 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007325 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007326
7327 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
7328 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
7329 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
7330 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
7331 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
7332 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
7333 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007334 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
7335 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7336 possible that the client has already brought one.
7337
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007338 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007339 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007340 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007341 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007342 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007343 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007344
7345 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7346 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7347 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7348 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7349 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7350 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7351 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7352
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007353 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
7354 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
7355 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
7356 are under the control of the end-user.
7357
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007358 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007359 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7360 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007361 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
7362 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
7363 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007364
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007365 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007366 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
7367 frontend www
7368 mode http
7369 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
7370
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007371 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
7372 backend www
7373 mode http
7374 option forwardfor header X-Client
7375
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007376 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007377 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007378
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007379
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02007380option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7381no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7382 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
7383 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7384 yes | yes | yes | no
7385 Arguments : none
7386
7387 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7388 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7389 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7390 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7391 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7392 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7393 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7394
7395 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
7396 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
7397 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
7398 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7399 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
7400 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7401 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7402 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
7403 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7404 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7405
7406 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
7407
7408 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7409 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7410
7411 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
7412 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7413
7414
7415option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7416no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7417 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
7418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7419 yes | no | yes | yes
7420 Arguments : none
7421
7422 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7423 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7424 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7425 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7426 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7427 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7428 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7429
7430 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
7431 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
7432 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
7433 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7434 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
7435 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7436 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7437 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
7438 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7439 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7440
7441 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
7442
7443 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7444 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7445
7446 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
7447 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7448
7449
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007450option http-buffer-request
7451no option http-buffer-request
7452 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
7453 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7454 yes | yes | yes | yes
7455 Arguments : none
7456
7457 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
7458 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
7459 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
7460 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
7461 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
7462 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01007463 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
7464 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
7465 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
7466 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007467
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01007468 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007469
7470
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007471option http-ignore-probes
7472no option http-ignore-probes
7473 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
7474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7475 yes | yes | yes | no
7476 Arguments : none
7477
7478 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
7479 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
7480 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
7481 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
7482 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
7483 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
7484 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
7485 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
7486 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007487 was received over a connection before it was closed;
7488 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007489 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
7490
7491 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
7492 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
7493 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
7494 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
7495 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
7496 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
7497 are often the only way to detect them.
7498
7499 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7500 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7501
7502 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
7503
7504
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007505option http-keep-alive
7506no option http-keep-alive
7507 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
7508 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7509 yes | yes | yes | yes
7510 Arguments : none
7511
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007512 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7513 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007514 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7515 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007516 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
7517 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
7518 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007519
7520 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
7521 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007522 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
7523 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
7524 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
7525 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
7526 situations where this option may be useful :
7527
7528 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007529 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007530
7531 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
7532 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
7533
7534 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
7535 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
7536 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
7537 request.
7538
7539 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
7540 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007541 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
7542 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
7543 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007544
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007545 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7546 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7547 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7548 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
7549 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7550 not set.
7551
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007552 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7553 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
7554 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007555
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007556 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007557 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01007558 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007559
7560
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007561option http-no-delay
7562no option http-no-delay
7563 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
7564 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7565 yes | yes | yes | yes
7566 Arguments : none
7567
7568 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
7569 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
7570 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
7571 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
7572 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
7573 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
7574 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
7575 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
7576 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
7577 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
7578 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
7579 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
7580 affected.
7581
7582 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
7583 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
7584 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
7585 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
7586 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
7587 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
7588 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
7589 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
7590 latency environments.
7591
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007592 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7593
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007594
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007595option http-pretend-keepalive
7596no option http-pretend-keepalive
7597 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
7598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007599 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007600 Arguments : none
7601
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007602 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007603 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
7604 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
7605 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
7606 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
7607 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
7608 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
7609 consider the response complete.
7610
7611 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
7612 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
7613 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
7614 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007615 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007616 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
7617
7618 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
7619 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
7620 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
7621 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
7622 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
7623 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
7624 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
7625
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007626 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
7627 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
7628 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
7629 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
7630 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
7631 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007632
7633 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7634 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7635
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007636 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007637 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007638
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007639
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007640option http-server-close
7641no option http-server-close
7642 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
7643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7644 yes | yes | yes | yes
7645 Arguments : none
7646
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007647 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7648 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7649 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7650 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007651 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
7652 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
7653 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
7654 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
7655 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
7656 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
7657 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
7658 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
7659 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
7660 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
7661 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007662
7663 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7664 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7665 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7666 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007667 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7668 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007669
7670 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7671 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007672 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7673 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7674 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007675
7676 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7677 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7678
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007679 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
7680 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007681
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007682option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007683no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007684 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
7685 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7686 yes | yes | yes | no
7687 Arguments : none
7688
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00007689 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007690 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
7691 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
7692 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
7693 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
7694 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
7695 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
7696
7697 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
7698 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007699 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
7700 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
7701 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007702
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01007703 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
7704 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
7705 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
7706 front of an existing proxy.
7707
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007708 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
7709
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007710 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007711
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007712option httpchk
7713option httpchk <uri>
7714option httpchk <method> <uri>
7715option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007716 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007717 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7718 yes | no | yes | yes
7719 Arguments :
7720 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
7721 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
7722 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
7723 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
7724 ones.
7725
7726 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
7727 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
7728 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
7729
7730 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
7731 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
7732 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007733 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007734
7735 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
7736 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
7737 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
7738 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
7739 the lack of any response.
7740
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007741 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
7742 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
7743 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
7744 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
7745
7746 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
7747 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
7748 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007749
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007750 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
7751 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02007752 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
7753 internally relies on an HTX mutliplexer. Thus, it means the request
7754 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007755
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007756 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
7757 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
7758 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
7759 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
7760
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007761 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007762 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
7763 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
7764 backend https_relay
7765 mode tcp
7766 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
7767 http-check send hdr Host www
7768 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007769
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09007770 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
7771 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
7772 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007773
7774
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007775option httpclose
7776no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007777 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007778 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7779 yes | yes | yes | yes
7780 Arguments : none
7781
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007782 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7783 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7784 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7785 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007786 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007787
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007788 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
7789 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05007790 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007791 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
7792 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007793
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007794 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
7795 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
7796 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007797
7798 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7799 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007800 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
7801 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7802 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007803
7804 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7805 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7806
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007807 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007808
7809
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007810option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007811 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
7812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007813 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007814 Arguments :
7815 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
7816 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
7817 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007818 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007819 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007820
7821 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7822 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7823 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
7824 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
7825 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
7826 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
7827 ports.
7828
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01007829 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
7830 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007831
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007832 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7833
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007834 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007835
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007836
7837option http_proxy
7838no option http_proxy
7839 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
7840 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7841 yes | yes | yes | yes
7842 Arguments : none
7843
7844 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
7845 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
7846 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
7847 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
7848 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
7849
7850 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
7851 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007852 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
7853 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007854
7855 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7856 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7857
7858 Example :
7859 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
7860 backend direct_forward
7861 option httpclose
7862 option http_proxy
7863
7864 See also : "option httpclose"
7865
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007866
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007867option independent-streams
7868no option independent-streams
7869 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7871 yes | yes | yes | yes
7872 Arguments : none
7873
7874 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
7875 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
7876 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
7877 receive data or not.
7878
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007879 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007880 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
7881 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
7882 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
7883 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
7884 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
7885 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
7886 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
7887 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
7888 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
7889 socket buffers.
7890
7891 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
7892 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
7893 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
7894 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
7895 slow lines, so use it with caution.
7896
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007897 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007898
7899
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02007900option ldap-check
7901 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
7902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7903 yes | no | yes | yes
7904 Arguments : none
7905
7906 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
7907 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
7908 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
7909 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
7910
7911 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
7912 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
7913
7914 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
7915 configure it.
7916
7917 Example :
7918 option ldap-check
7919
7920 See also : "option httpchk"
7921
7922
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007923option external-check
7924 Use external processes for server health checks
7925 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7926 yes | no | yes | yes
7927
7928 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
7929 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
7930 command".
7931
7932 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
7933
7934 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
7935
7936
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007937option log-health-checks
7938no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007939 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007940 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7941 yes | no | yes | yes
7942 Arguments : none
7943
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007944 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
7945 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
7946 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007947
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007948 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
7949 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
7950 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
7951 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
7952 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
7953
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007954 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007955 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007956
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007957 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
7958 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
7959 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007960
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007961
7962option log-separate-errors
7963no option log-separate-errors
7964 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
7965 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7966 yes | yes | yes | no
7967 Arguments : none
7968
7969 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
7970 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
7971 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
7972 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
7973 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
7974 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
7975 provides very important information.
7976
7977 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
7978 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
7979 error logs.
7980
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007981 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007982 logging.
7983
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007984
7985option logasap
7986no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007987 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7989 yes | yes | yes | no
7990 Arguments : none
7991
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007992 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
7993 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
7994 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
7995 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
7996
7997 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
7998 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
7999 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
8000 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
8001 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008002 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008003 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
8004 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
8005 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
8006 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008007 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008008
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008009 Examples :
8010 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
8011 mode http
8012 option httplog
8013 option logasap
8014 log 192.168.2.200 local3
8015
8016 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8017 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8018 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
8019 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
8020
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008021 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008022 logging.
8023
8024
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008025option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008026 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008027 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8028 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008029 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008030 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
8031 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008032 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
8033 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008034
8035 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
8036 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008037 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008038 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
8039 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
8040 in the MySQL table, like this :
8041
8042 USE mysql;
8043 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
8044 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
8045
8046 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008047 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008048 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
8049 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
8050 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
8051 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
8052 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
8053 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
8054 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
8055
8056 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
8057 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008058
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02008059 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008060
8061 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
8062 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
8063 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8064 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008065 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
8066 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008067
8068 See also: "option httpchk"
8069
8070
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008071option nolinger
8072no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008073 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008074 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8075 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008076 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008077
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008078 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008079 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
8080 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
8081 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
8082 connections.
8083
8084 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
8085 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
8086 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
8087 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
8088 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
8089 this too.
8090
8091 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
8092 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
8093 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
8094
8095 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
8096 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
8097 for servers.
8098
8099 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8100 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8101
8102
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008103option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
8104 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
8105 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8106 yes | yes | yes | yes
8107 Arguments :
8108 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8109 matching <network>
8110 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
8111 header name.
8112
8113 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
8114 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
8115 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
8116 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
8117 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
8118 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
8119 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
8120 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
8121 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8122 possible that the client has already brought one.
8123
8124 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
8125 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
8126 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
8127 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
8128 header and requires different one.
8129
8130 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8131 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8132 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8133 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8134 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8135 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
8136 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
8137
8138 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
8139 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8140 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
8141 both are defined.
8142
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008143 Examples :
8144 # Original Destination address
8145 frontend www
8146 mode http
8147 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
8148
8149 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
8150 backend www
8151 mode http
8152 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
8153
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008154 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008155
8156
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008157option persist
8158no option persist
8159 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
8160 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8161 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008162 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008163
8164 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
8165 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
8166 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
8167 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
8168 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
8169 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
8170 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
8171 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
8172 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
8173 redirected to another valid server.
8174
8175 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8176 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8177
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01008178 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008179
8180
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01008181option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
8182 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
8183 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8184 yes | no | yes | yes
8185 Arguments :
8186 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
8187 PostgreSQL server.
8188
8189 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
8190 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
8191 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
8192 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
8193
8194 See also: "option httpchk"
8195
8196
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008197option prefer-last-server
8198no option prefer-last-server
8199 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
8200 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8201 yes | no | yes | yes
8202 Arguments : none
8203
8204 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
8205 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
8206 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
8207 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
8208 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
8209 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
8210 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
8211 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
8212 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008213 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
8214 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02008215 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
8216 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
8217 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008218 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
8219 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
8220 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008221
8222 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8223 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8224
8225 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
8226
8227
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008228option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008229option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008230no option redispatch
8231 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
8232 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8233 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008234 Arguments :
8235 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
8236 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
8237 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008238 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008239 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008240 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008241 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
8242 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
8243 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
8244
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008245
8246 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
8247 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
8248 be able to access the service anymore.
8249
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01008250 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
8251 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008252
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02008253 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
8254 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
8255 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
8256 following order:
8257
8258 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
8259
8260 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
8261 list, or
8262
8263 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
8264
8265 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
8266 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
8267
8268 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
8269 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
8270 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
8271 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
8272
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008273 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008274 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
8275 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008276
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008277 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8278 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8279
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008280 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008281
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008282
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008283option redis-check
8284 Use redis health checks for server testing
8285 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8286 yes | no | yes | yes
8287 Arguments : none
8288
8289 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
8290 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8291 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
8292 find the "+PONG" response message.
8293
8294 Example :
8295 option redis-check
8296
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008297 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008298
8299
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008300option smtpchk
8301option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
8302 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
8303 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8304 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008305 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008306 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02008307 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008308 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
8309
8310 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
8311 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
8312 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
8313
8314 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
8315 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
8316 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
8317 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
8318 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
8319 dead server.
8320
8321 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
8322 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008323 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008324 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
8325
8326 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
8327 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
8328 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8329 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008330 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008331
8332 Example :
8333 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
8334
8335 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
8336
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008337
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02008338option socket-stats
8339no option socket-stats
8340
8341 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
8342 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8343 yes | yes | yes | no
8344
8345 Arguments : none
8346
8347
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008348option splice-auto
8349no option splice-auto
8350 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
8351 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8352 yes | yes | yes | yes
8353 Arguments : none
8354
8355 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
8356 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008357 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008358 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008359 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008360 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
8361 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
8362 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
8363 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8364
8365 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
8366 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
8367 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
8368 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
8369 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
8370 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
8371 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
8372 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
8373 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
8374 keyword.
8375
8376 Example :
8377 option splice-auto
8378
8379 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8380 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8381
8382 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
8383 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8384
8385
8386option splice-request
8387no option splice-request
8388 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
8389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8390 yes | yes | yes | yes
8391 Arguments : none
8392
8393 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008394 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008395 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8396 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8397 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8398 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8399
8400 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8401
8402 Example :
8403 option splice-request
8404
8405 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8406 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8407
8408 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
8409 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8410
8411
8412option splice-response
8413no option splice-response
8414 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
8415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8416 yes | yes | yes | yes
8417 Arguments : none
8418
8419 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008420 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008421 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8422 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8423 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8424 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8425
8426 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8427
8428 Example :
8429 option splice-response
8430
8431 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8432 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8433
8434 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
8435 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8436
8437
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01008438option spop-check
8439 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
8440 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8441 no | no | no | yes
8442 Arguments : none
8443
8444 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
8445 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8446 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
8447 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
8448
8449 Example :
8450 option spop-check
8451
8452 See also : "option httpchk"
8453
8454
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008455option srvtcpka
8456no option srvtcpka
8457 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
8458 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8459 yes | no | yes | yes
8460 Arguments : none
8461
8462 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8463 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008464 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008465 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8466
8467 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8468 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8469 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8470 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8471
8472 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8473 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8474 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8475 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8476 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8477
8478 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8479
8480 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8481 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8482 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
8483
8484 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8485 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8486
8487 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
8488
8489
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008490option ssl-hello-chk
8491 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
8492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8493 yes | no | yes | yes
8494 Arguments : none
8495
8496 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
8497 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
8498 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
8499 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
8500 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
8501 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
8502 hello message.
8503
8504 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
8505 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
8506 messages, which is appreciable.
8507
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008508 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
8509 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
8510 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008511
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008512 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
8513
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008514
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008515option tcp-check
8516 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
8517 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8518 yes | no | yes | yes
8519
8520 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
8521 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
8522
8523 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
8524 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
8525 attempt, which remains the default mode.
8526
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008527 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008528 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
8529 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
8530 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
8531 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
8532 only.
8533
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008534 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008535 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
8536 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
8537 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
8538 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
8539
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008540 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008541 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
8542 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008543 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008544 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
8545 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
8546 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
8547 the respective protocols.
8548 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008549 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008550
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008551 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008552
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008553 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
8554 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
8555 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
8556 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008557
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008558 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
8559 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
8560 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01008561
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008562
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008563 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008564 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008565 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008566 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008567
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008568 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008569 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008570 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008571
8572 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
8573 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008574 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008575 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008576 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008577 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008578 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008579 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008580 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8581 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008582 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008583 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8584 tcp-check expect string +OK
8585
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008586 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008587 (send many headers before analyzing)
8588 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008589 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008590 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
8591 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
8592 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
8593 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008594 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008595
8596
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008597 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008598
8599
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008600option tcp-smart-accept
8601no option tcp-smart-accept
8602 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
8603 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8604 yes | yes | yes | no
8605 Arguments : none
8606
8607 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
8608 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
8609 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
8610 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
8611 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
8612 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
8613
8614 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
8615 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
8616 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
8617 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
8618
8619 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
8620 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
8621 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008622 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008623
8624 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
8625 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
8626 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
8627
8628 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
8629 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
8630 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
8631
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02008632 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
8633
8634
8635option tcp-smart-connect
8636no option tcp-smart-connect
8637 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
8638 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8639 yes | no | yes | yes
8640 Arguments : none
8641
8642 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
8643 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
8644 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
8645 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
8646 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
8647
8648 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
8649 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
8650 complex.
8651
8652 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
8653 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
8654 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
8655
8656 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8657 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8658
8659 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
8660
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008661
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008662option tcpka
8663 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
8664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8665 yes | yes | yes | yes
8666 Arguments : none
8667
8668 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8669 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008670 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008671 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8672
8673 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8674 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8675 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8676 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8677
8678 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8679 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8680 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8681 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8682 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8683
8684 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8685
8686 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
8687 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
8688 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
8689 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
8690 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
8691 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
8692 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
8693 backends.
8694
8695 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
8696
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008697
8698option tcplog
8699 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
8700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008701 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008702 Arguments : none
8703
8704 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8705 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8706 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
8707 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
8708 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
8709 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
8710 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
8711 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
8712
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008713 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8714
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008715 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008716
8717
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008718option transparent
8719no option transparent
8720 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8721 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008722 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008723 Arguments : none
8724
8725 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
8726 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8727 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8728 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8729 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8730 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8731 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8732 appropriate server.
8733
8734 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8735 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8736
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01008737 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008738 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008739
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008740
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008741external-check command <command>
8742 Executable to run when performing an external-check
8743 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8744 yes | no | yes | yes
8745
8746 Arguments :
8747 <command> is the external command to run
8748
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008749 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
8750
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008751 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008752
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008753 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
8754 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
8755 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
8756 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
8757 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
8758 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008759
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01008760 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
8761
8762 Environment variables :
8763 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
8764 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
8765
8766 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
8767
8768 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
8769
8770 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
8771 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
8772 for a UNIX socket).
8773
8774 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
8775
8776 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
8777
8778 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
8779
8780 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
8781
8782 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
8783
8784 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
8785 socket).
8786
8787 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
8788 the command may be set using "external-check path".
8789
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02008790 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
8791
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008792 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
8793 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
8794 failed.
8795
8796 Example :
8797 external-check command /bin/true
8798
8799 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
8800
8801
8802external-check path <path>
8803 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
8804 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8805 yes | no | yes | yes
8806
8807 Arguments :
8808 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
8809
8810 The default path is "".
8811
8812 Example :
8813 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
8814
8815 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
8816 "external-check command"
8817
8818
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008819persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008820persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008821 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
8822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8823 yes | no | yes | yes
8824 Arguments :
8825 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008826 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
8827 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008828
8829 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
8830 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008831 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008832 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
8833 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
8834 forwarded to this server.
8835
8836 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
8837 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
8838 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008839 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008840 a single "listen" section.
8841
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008842 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
8843 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
8844 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
8845
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008846 Example :
8847 listen tse-farm
8848 bind :3389
8849 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
8850 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8851 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
8852 # apply RDP cookie persistence
8853 persist rdp-cookie
8854 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008855 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008856 balance rdp-cookie
8857 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
8858 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
8859
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008860 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
8861 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008862
8863
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008864rate-limit sessions <rate>
8865 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
8866 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8867 yes | yes | yes | no
8868 Arguments :
8869 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
8870 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
8871
8872 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
8873 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
8874 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
8875 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
8876 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
8877 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
8878
8879 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
8880 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
8881 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
8882 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
8883
8884 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
8885 listen smtp
8886 mode tcp
8887 bind :25
8888 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02008889 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008890
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02008891 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
8892 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
8893 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008894
8895 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
8896
8897
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008898redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8899redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8900redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008901 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
8902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8903 no | yes | yes | yes
8904
8905 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01008906 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008907
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008908 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008909 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008910 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
8911 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
8912 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008913
8914 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
8915 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
8916 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
8917 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
8918 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008919 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
8920 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
8921 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
8922 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008923
8924 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
8925 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
8926 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
8927 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
8928 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
8929 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008930 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008931 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008932 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
8933 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
8934 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008935
8936 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008937 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
8938 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
8939 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02008940 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008941 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
8942 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
8943 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
8944 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008945
8946 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008947 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008948
8949 - "drop-query"
8950 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
8951 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
8952 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
8953 with a location-type redirect.
8954
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008955 - "append-slash"
8956 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
8957 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
8958 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
8959 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
8960
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008961 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
8962 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
8963 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
8964 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
8965 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
8966 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
8967 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
8968
8969 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
8970 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
8971 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
8972 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
8973 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
8974 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
8975 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008976
8977 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
8978 acl clear dst_port 80
8979 acl secure dst_port 8080
8980 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008981 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008982 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008983 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
8984
8985 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008986 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
8987 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
8988 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008989 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008990
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008991 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
8992 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
8993 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
8994
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008995 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01008996 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008997
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008998 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02008999 http-request redirect code 301 location \
9000 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
9001 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009002
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009003 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009004
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01009005
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009006retries <value>
9007 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
9008 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9009 yes | no | yes | yes
9010 Arguments :
9011 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
9012 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
9013 default value is 3.
9014
9015 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
9016 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
9017 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
9018
9019 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009020 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
9021 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009022
9023 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
9024 server even if a cookie references a different server.
9025
9026 See also : "option redispatch"
9027
9028
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009029retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +02009030 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
9031 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
9032 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009033 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9034 yes | no | yes | yes
9035 Arguments :
9036 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
9037 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
9038 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
9039 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
9040
9041 none never retry
9042
9043 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
9044 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
9045
9046 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
9047 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
9048 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
9049 request timeout on the server side, poor network
9050 condition, or a server crash or restart while
9051 processing the request.
9052
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02009053 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
9054 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
9055 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
9056 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
9057 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
9058 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
9059 overflow attack for example).
9060
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009061 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
9062 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
9063 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
9064 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
9065 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
9066 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
9067 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
9068 amplify denial of service attacks.
9069
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02009070 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
9071 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
9072 considered to be safe to retry.
9073
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009074 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
9075 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
9076 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
9077 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
9078
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02009079 all-retryable-errors
9080 retry request for any error that are considered
9081 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
9082 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
9083 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
9084
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009085 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
9086 not cumulative.
9087
9088 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
9089 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
9090 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
9091 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
9092
9093 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
9094 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
9095 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
9096 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
9097 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
9098 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
9099 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
9100 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
9101 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
9102 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
9103 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
9104 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
9105
9106 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
9107 should not use this directive.
9108
9109 The default is "conn-failure".
9110
9111 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
9112
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009113server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009114 Declare a server in a backend
9115 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9116 no | no | yes | yes
9117 Arguments :
9118 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009119 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009120 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009121
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009122 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
9123 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
9124 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
9125 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02009126 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
9127 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
9128 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
9129 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
9130 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009131 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
9132 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
9133 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
9134 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
9135 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9136 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9137 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009138 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02009139 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
9140 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
9141 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
9142 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
9143 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
9144 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009145 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9146 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01009147 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
9148 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009149
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009150 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009151 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
9152 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
9153 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
9154 adding this value to the client's port.
9155
9156 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
9157 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009158 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009159
9160 Examples :
9161 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
9162 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009163 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009164 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
9165 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
9166 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009167
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02009168 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
9169 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
9170 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
9171 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
9172 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
9173
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009174 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
9175 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009176
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009177server-state-file-name [<file>]
9178 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
9179 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
9180 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
9181 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
9182 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
9183 global directive "server-state-file-base".
9184
9185 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
9186 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
9187
9188 global
9189 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
9190
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01009191 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009192 load-server-state-from-file
9193
9194 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
9195 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009196
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02009197server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
9198 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
9199 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
9200 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9201 no | no | yes | yes
9202
9203 Arguments:
9204 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
9205
9206 <num | range>
9207 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
9208 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
9209 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
9210 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
9211
9212 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
9213
9214 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
9215
9216 <params*>
9217 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
9218 keyword.
9219
9220 Examples:
9221 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
9222 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
9223 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
9224
9225 # or
9226 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
9227
9228 # would be equivalent to:
9229 server srv1 google.com:80 check
9230 server srv2 google.com:80 check
9231 server srv3 google.com:80 check
9232
9233
9234
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009235source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009236source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009237source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009238 Set the source address for outgoing connections
9239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9240 yes | no | yes | yes
9241 Arguments :
9242 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
9243 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009244
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009245 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009246 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
9247 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
9248 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
9249 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
9250 supported prefixes are :
9251 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9252 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9253 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009254 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02009255 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9256 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009257
9258 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
9259 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009260 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
9261 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
9262 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009263
9264 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
9265 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
9266 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
9267 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
9268 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
9269 <addr>.
9270
9271 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
9272 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
9273 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
9274 port.
9275
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009276 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
9277 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
9278 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
9279 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01009280 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009281 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
9282 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
9283 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
9284 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
9285 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
9286 HTTP header.
9287
9288 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
9289 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009290 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009291 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
9292 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
9293 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
9294 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
9295 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
9296 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
9297 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
9298
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009299 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
9300 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
9301 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
9302 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
9303 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
9304 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
9305
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009306 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
9307 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
9308 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
9309 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
9310
9311 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
9312 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
9313 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
9314 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
9315 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
9316 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
9317
9318 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
9319 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
9320 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
9321 there are two methods :
9322
9323 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
9324 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
9325 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
9326 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
9327 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
9328 of the client ranges may be used.
9329
9330 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
9331 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
9332 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
9333 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
9334 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
9335 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
9336 same session.
9337
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009338 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
9339 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
9340 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009341 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009342
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02009343 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
9344
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009345 Examples :
9346 backend private
9347 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
9348 source 192.168.1.200
9349
9350 backend transparent_ssl1
9351 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
9352 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9353
9354 backend transparent_ssl2
9355 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
9356 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
9357 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
9358
9359 backend transparent_ssl3
9360 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
9361 # is more conntrack-friendly.
9362 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9363
9364 backend transparent_smtp
9365 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
9366 # with Tproxy version 4.
9367 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
9368
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009369 backend transparent_http
9370 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
9371 # proxy.
9372 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
9373
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009374 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009375 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
9376
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009377
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009378stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
9379 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
9380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009381 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009382
9383 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
9384 matched.
9385
9386 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
9387 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
9388
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009389 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9390 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009391 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009392
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01009393 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
9394 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
9395 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
9396 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009397
9398 Example :
9399 # statistics admin level only for localhost
9400 backend stats_localhost
9401 stats enable
9402 stats admin if LOCALHOST
9403
9404 Example :
9405 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
9406 backend stats_auth
9407 stats enable
9408 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
9409 stats admin if TRUE
9410
9411 Example :
9412 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
9413 userlist stats-auth
9414 group admin users admin
9415 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
9416 group readonly users haproxy
9417 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
9418
9419 backend stats_auth
9420 stats enable
9421 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
9422 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
9423 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
9424 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
9425
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009426 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
9427 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
9428 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009429
9430
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009431stats auth <user>:<passwd>
9432 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
9433 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009434 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009435 Arguments :
9436 <user> is a user name to grant access to
9437
9438 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
9439
9440 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
9441 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
9442 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
9443 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
9444 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
9445 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
9446
9447 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
9448 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
9449 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009450 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009451
9452 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
9453 report using "stats scope".
9454
9455 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9456 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9457 unobvious parameters.
9458
9459 Example :
9460 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9461 backend public_www
9462 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9463 stats enable
9464 stats hide-version
9465 stats scope .
9466 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009467 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009468 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9469 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9470
9471 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9472 backend private_monitoring
9473 stats enable
9474 stats uri /admin?stats
9475 stats refresh 5s
9476
9477 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
9478
9479
9480stats enable
9481 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
9482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009483 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009484 Arguments : none
9485
9486 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
9487 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
9488 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
9489 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
9490 - stats auth : no authentication
9491 - stats scope : no restriction
9492
9493 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9494 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9495 unobvious parameters.
9496
9497 Example :
9498 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9499 backend public_www
9500 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9501 stats enable
9502 stats hide-version
9503 stats scope .
9504 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009505 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009506 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9507 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9508
9509 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9510 backend private_monitoring
9511 stats enable
9512 stats uri /admin?stats
9513 stats refresh 5s
9514
9515 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9516
9517
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009518stats hide-version
9519 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009521 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009522 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009523
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009524 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
9525 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
9526 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
9527 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
9528 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
9529 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009530
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009531 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9532 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9533 unobvious parameters.
9534
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009535 Example :
9536 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9537 backend public_www
9538 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009539 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009540 stats hide-version
9541 stats scope .
9542 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009543 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009544 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9545 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009546
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009547 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9548 backend private_monitoring
9549 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009550 stats uri /admin?stats
9551 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01009552
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009553 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009554
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009555
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02009556stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
9557 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
9558 Access control for statistics
9559
9560 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9561 no | no | yes | yes
9562
9563 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
9564 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
9565 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
9566 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
9567 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
9568 should be asked to enter a username and password.
9569
9570 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
9571 instance.
9572
9573 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
9574 about ACL usage.
9575
9576
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009577stats realm <realm>
9578 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
9579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009580 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009581 Arguments :
9582 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
9583 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
9584 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
9585
9586 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
9587 using a backslash ('\').
9588
9589 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
9590 only related to authentication.
9591
9592 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9593 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9594 unobvious parameters.
9595
9596 Example :
9597 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9598 backend public_www
9599 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9600 stats enable
9601 stats hide-version
9602 stats scope .
9603 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009604 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009605 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9606 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9607
9608 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9609 backend private_monitoring
9610 stats enable
9611 stats uri /admin?stats
9612 stats refresh 5s
9613
9614 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
9615
9616
9617stats refresh <delay>
9618 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
9619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009620 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009621 Arguments :
9622 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
9623 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
9624 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
9625 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
9626 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
9627 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
9628
9629 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
9630 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
9631 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
9632 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
9633
9634 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9635 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9636 unobvious parameters.
9637
9638 Example :
9639 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9640 backend public_www
9641 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9642 stats enable
9643 stats hide-version
9644 stats scope .
9645 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009646 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009647 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9648 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9649
9650 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9651 backend private_monitoring
9652 stats enable
9653 stats uri /admin?stats
9654 stats refresh 5s
9655
9656 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9657
9658
9659stats scope { <name> | "." }
9660 Enable statistics and limit access scope
9661 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009662 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009663 Arguments :
9664 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
9665 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
9666 section in which the statement appears.
9667
9668 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
9669 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
9670 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
9671 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
9672 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
9673 exists.
9674
9675 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9676 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9677 unobvious parameters.
9678
9679 Example :
9680 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9681 backend public_www
9682 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9683 stats enable
9684 stats hide-version
9685 stats scope .
9686 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009687 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009688 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9689 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9690
9691 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9692 backend private_monitoring
9693 stats enable
9694 stats uri /admin?stats
9695 stats refresh 5s
9696
9697 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9698
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009699
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009700stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009701 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
9702 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009703 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009704
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009705 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009706 description from global section is automatically used instead.
9707
9708 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9709 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
9710
9711 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9712 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009713 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009714
9715 Example :
9716 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9717 backend private_monitoring
9718 stats enable
9719 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
9720 stats uri /admin?stats
9721 stats refresh 5s
9722
9723 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
9724 global section.
9725
9726
9727stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009728 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
9729 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9730 yes | yes | yes | yes
9731 Arguments : none
9732
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009733 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009734 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
9735 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
9736 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
9737 - IP (socket, server)
9738 - cookie (backend, server)
9739
9740 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9741 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009742 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009743
9744 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
9745
9746
9747stats show-node [ <name> ]
9748 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
9749 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009750 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009751 Arguments:
9752 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
9753 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
9754
9755 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9756 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009757 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009758
9759 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9760 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9761 unobvious parameters.
9762
9763 Example:
9764 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9765 backend private_monitoring
9766 stats enable
9767 stats show-node Europe-1
9768 stats uri /admin?stats
9769 stats refresh 5s
9770
9771 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
9772 section.
9773
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009774
9775stats uri <prefix>
9776 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
9777 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009778 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009779 Arguments :
9780 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
9781 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
9782 query string.
9783
9784 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
9785 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
9786 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
9787 possible to reach it in the application.
9788
9789 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009790 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009791 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
9792 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
9793 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
9794 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
9795
9796 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
9797 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
9798 an address or a port to statistics only.
9799
9800 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9801 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9802 unobvious parameters.
9803
9804 Example :
9805 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9806 backend public_www
9807 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9808 stats enable
9809 stats hide-version
9810 stats scope .
9811 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009812 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009813 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9814 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9815
9816 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9817 backend private_monitoring
9818 stats enable
9819 stats uri /admin?stats
9820 stats refresh 5s
9821
9822 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
9823
9824
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009825stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
9826 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009827 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009828 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009829
9830 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009831 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009832 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009833 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009834 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
9835
9836 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9837 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9838 the "stick-table" statement.
9839
9840 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
9841 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
9842 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
9843 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
9844 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
9845
9846 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9847 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
9848 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
9849 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
9850 transformation rules.
9851
9852 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9853 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9854 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9855 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9856 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9857 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9858 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9859
9860 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
9861 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
9862 ACL based conditions.
9863
9864 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
9865 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
9866 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
9867 matches can be used as fallbacks.
9868
9869 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
9870 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
9871 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
9872 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
9873
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009874 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9875 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009876 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009877
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009878 Example :
9879 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9880 # last 30 minutes
9881 backend pop
9882 mode tcp
9883 balance roundrobin
9884 stick store-request src
9885 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9886 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9887 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9888
9889 backend smtp
9890 mode tcp
9891 balance roundrobin
9892 stick match src table pop
9893 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9894 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9895
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009896 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009897 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009898
9899
9900stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9901 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
9902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9903 no | no | yes | yes
9904
9905 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
9906 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
9907 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
9908 for writing more maintainable configurations.
9909
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009910 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9911 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009912 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009913
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009914 Examples :
9915 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01009916 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009917
9918 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
9919 stick match src table pop if !localhost
9920 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
9921
9922
9923 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
9924 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
9925 backend http
9926 mode http
9927 balance roundrobin
9928 stick on src table https
9929 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9930 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9931 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9932
9933 backend https
9934 mode tcp
9935 balance roundrobin
9936 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9937 stick on src
9938 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9939 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9940
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009941 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009942
9943
9944stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9945 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9946 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9947 no | no | yes | yes
9948
9949 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009950 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009951 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009952 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009953 server is selected.
9954
9955 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9956 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9957 the "stick-table" statement.
9958
9959 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9960 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9961 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9962 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9963 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9964 address.
9965
9966 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9967 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
9968 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
9969 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
9970 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
9971 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
9972 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
9973 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
9974 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
9975 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
9976
9977 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9978 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9979 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9980 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9981 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9982 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9983 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9984
9985 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9986 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9987 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9988 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9989
9990 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9991 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9992 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9993 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9994 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9995 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009996 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9997 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9998 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9999 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10000 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10001 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010002
10003 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
10004 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
10005 the request.
10006
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010007 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10008 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010009 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010010
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010011 Example :
10012 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10013 # last 30 minutes
10014 backend pop
10015 mode tcp
10016 balance roundrobin
10017 stick store-request src
10018 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10019 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10020 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10021
10022 backend smtp
10023 mode tcp
10024 balance roundrobin
10025 stick match src table pop
10026 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10027 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10028
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010029 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010030 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010031
10032
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010033stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010034 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
10035 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080010036 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010038 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010039
10040 Arguments :
10041 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
10042 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
10043 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10044 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10045
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010010046 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
10047 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
10048 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10049 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10050
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010051 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
10052 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
10053 instance.
10054
10055 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
10056 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
10057 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
10058 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
10059 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
10060 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010061 to 32 characters.
10062
10063 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
10064 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
10065 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010066 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010067 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
10068 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010069
10070 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010071 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
10072 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010073 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
10074 increase.
10075
10076 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010077 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
10078 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
10079 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010080
10081 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
10082 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
10083 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
10084 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010085 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010086 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
10087 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
10088 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
10089 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
10090 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
10091 parameter (see below).
10092
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010093 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
10094 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
10095 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
10096 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
10097 soft restart.
10098
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020010099 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
10100 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010101
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010102 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
10103 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
10104 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
10105 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010106 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010107 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010108 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
10109 if not expiration delay is specified.
10110
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010111 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
10112 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
10113 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
10114 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010115 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
10116 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
10117 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
10118 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
10119 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
10120 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
10121 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
10122 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
10123 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
10124 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
10125 types and their arguments.
10126
10127 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
10128 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
10129 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
10130 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
10131
10132 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10133 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10134 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010135 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010136
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010137 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10138 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10139 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010140 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010141 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010142 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010143
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010144 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10145 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10146 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
10147 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
10148
10149 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
10150 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10151 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
10152 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
10153 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
10154 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
10155
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010156 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10157 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
10158 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
10159 they were received.
10160
10161 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10162 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
10163 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
10164 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
10165 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
10166
10167 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10168 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10169 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10170 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
10171 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10172
10173 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10174 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
10175 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
10176
10177 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10178 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10179 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10180 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
10181 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10182
10183 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10184 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
10185 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
10186 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
10187 the client side.
10188
10189 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10190 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10191 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10192 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
10193 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
10194 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
10195 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
10196
10197 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10198 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
10199 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
10200 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
10201 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
10202 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010203 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010204
10205 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10206 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10207 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10208 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
10209 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
10210 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10211
10212 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010213 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010214 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
10215 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
10216
10217 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10218 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10219 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10220 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10221 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10222 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
10223 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
10224 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
10225 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
10226 recommended for better fairness.
10227
10228 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010229 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010230 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
10231 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
10232
10233 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
10234 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10235 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10236 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10237 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10238 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
10239 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
10240 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
10241 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
10242 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010243
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010244 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
10245 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010246 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
10247 reference it.
10248
10249 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
10250 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010010251 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
10252 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
10253 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010254
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010255 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
10256 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
10257 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
10258 something that can be ignored.
10259
10260 Example:
10261 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
10262 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
10263 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
10264 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
10265
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010266 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010010267 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010268
10269
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010270stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010010271 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010272 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10273 no | no | yes | yes
10274
10275 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010276 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010277 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010278 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010279 server is selected.
10280
10281 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10282 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10283 the "stick-table" statement.
10284
10285 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10286 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10287 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
10288 when the response is a SSL server hello.
10289
10290 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10291 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
10292 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
10293 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
10294 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
10295 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010296 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010297 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
10298 rules.
10299
10300 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10301 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10302 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10303 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10304 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10305 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10306 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10307
10308 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
10309 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10310 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
10311 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10312
10313 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
10314 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10315 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10316 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10317 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10318 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010319 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
10320 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10321 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10322 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10323 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10324 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
10325 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
10326 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
10327 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010328
10329 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
10330
10331 Example :
10332 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
10333 backend https
10334 mode tcp
10335 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010336 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010337 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010338
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010339 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
10340 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
10341
10342 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
10343 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10344 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
10345
10346 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
10347 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010348
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010349 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
10350 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
10351 # at offset 44.
10352
10353 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
10354 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
10355
10356 # Learn on response if server hello.
10357 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010358
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010359 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10360 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10361
10362 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
10363 extraction.
10364
10365
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010366tcp-check comment <string>
10367 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
10368 it fails.
10369 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10370 yes | no | yes | yes
10371
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010372 Arguments :
10373 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
10374 rule fails.
10375
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010376 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
10377 user-friendly error reporting.
10378
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010379 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
10380 "tcp-check expect".
10381
10382
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010383tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
10384 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010385 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010386 Opens a new connection
10387 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010388 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010389
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010390 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010391 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10392
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010393 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Christopher Fauletbb591a12020-04-01 16:52:17 +020010394 checks. The server options are used only if not redifined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010395
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010396 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010397 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
10398 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010399 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010400
10401 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010402
10403 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
10404
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020010405 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
10406
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010407 ssl opens a ciphered connection
10408
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020010409 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
10410
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020010411 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
10412 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
10413 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10414 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
10415
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010416 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
10417 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
10418 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
10419 haproxy -vv.
10420
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010421 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010422
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010423 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
10424 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
10425 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
10426
10427 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
10428 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
10429 of the sequence.
10430
10431 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
10432 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
10433 do.
10434
10435 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
10436 unset-var or comment rules.
10437
10438 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010439 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
10440 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
10441 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
10442 option tcp-check
10443 tcp-check connect
10444 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10445 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10446 tcp-check send \r\n
10447 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10448 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
10449 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10450 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10451 tcp-check send \r\n
10452 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10453 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
10454
10455 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
10456 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010457 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010458 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10459 tcp-check connect port 143
10460 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10461 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
10462
10463 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
10464
10465
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010466tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010467 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010468 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010469 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010470 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010471 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010472 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010473
10474 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010475 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10476
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010477 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
10478 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
10479 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
10480 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
10481 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
10482 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
10483 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
10484 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
10485 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
10486 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
10487
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010488 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010489 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
10490 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010491 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
10492 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
10493 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
10494
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010495 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10496 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
10497 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010498 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
10499 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
10500 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
10501 example 404 with disable-on-404
10502 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
10503 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010504 By default "L7OK" is used.
10505
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010506 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10507 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010508 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
10509 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
10510 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
10511 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
10512 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
10513 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010514
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010515 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010516 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010517 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
10518 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
10519 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
10520 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010521 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
10522
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020010523 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10524 informational message reported in logs if the expect
10525 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
10526 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
10527
10528 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10529 informational message reported in logs if an error
10530 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
10531 log-format string.
10532
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010533 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
10534 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
10535 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10536 followed by some converters.
10537
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010538 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
10539 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
10540 with the usual backslash ('\').
10541 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010542 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010543 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
10544 used upper or lower case.
10545
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010546 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
10547
10548 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
10549 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10550 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
10551 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10552 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
10553 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
10554 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
10555 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
10556
10557 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
10558 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10559 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
10560 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10561 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
10562 expression.
10563
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020010564 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
10565 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10566 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
10567 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
10568 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
10569 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
10570
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010571 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
10572 in the response buffer. A health check response will
10573 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
10574 this exact hexadecimal string.
10575 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
10576
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010577 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
10578 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
10579 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
10580 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
10581 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
10582 size of the original response. As such, the expected
10583 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
10584 size.
10585
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020010586 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
10587 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
10588 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
10589 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
10590 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
10591 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
10592 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
10593 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
10594 in a binary string before matching the response's
10595 buffer.
10596
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010597 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
10598 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
10599 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
10600 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
10601 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
10602 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
10603 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
10604 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
10605 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
10606 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
10607 the null character.
10608
10609 Examples :
10610 # perform a POP check
10611 option tcp-check
10612 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10613
10614 # perform an IMAP check
10615 option tcp-check
10616 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10617
10618 # look for the redis master server
10619 option tcp-check
10620 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020010621 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010622 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10623 tcp-check expect string role:master
10624 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
10625 tcp-check expect string +OK
10626
10627
10628 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
10629 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
10630
10631
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010632tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
10633tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
10634 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
10635 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010636 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010637 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010638
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010639 Arguments :
10640 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10641
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010642 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
10643 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020010644
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010645 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
10646 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010647
10648 Examples :
10649 # look for the redis master server
10650 option tcp-check
10651 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10652 tcp-check expect string role:master
10653
10654 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10655 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
10656
10657
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010658tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
10659tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
10660 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
10661 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010662 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010663 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010664
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010665 Arguments :
10666 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010667
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010668 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
10669 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020010670
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010671 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
10672 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
10673 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010674
10675 Examples :
10676 # redis check in binary
10677 option tcp-check
10678 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
10679 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
10680
10681
10682 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10683 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
10684
10685
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010686tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010687 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010688 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010689 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010690
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010691 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010692 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10693 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10694 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10695 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10696 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10697 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
10698 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
10699 and '-'.
10700
10701 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
10702
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010703 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010704 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
10705
10706
10707tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010708 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010709 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010710 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010711
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010712 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010713 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10714 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10715 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10716 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10717 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10718 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
10719 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
10720 and '-'.
10721
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010722 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010723 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
10724
10725
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010726tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10727 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10729 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010730 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010731 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10732 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010733
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010734 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010735
10736 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
10737 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010738 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
10739 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
10740 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
10741 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
10742 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
10743 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010744
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010745 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10746 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10747 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
10748 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010749
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010750 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010751 - accept :
10752 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10753 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10754 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010755
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010756 - reject :
10757 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10758 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10759 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
10760 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
10761 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
10762 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
10763 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
10764 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
10765 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
10766 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
10767 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010768 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010769
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010770 - expect-proxy layer4 :
10771 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
10772 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
10773 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
10774 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
10775 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
10776 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
10777 hosts.
10778
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010779 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
10780 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
10781 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
10782 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
10783 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
10784 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
10785 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
10786 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
10787
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010788 - capture <sample> len <length> :
10789 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
10790 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
10791 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
10792 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
10793 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
10794 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
10795 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
10796 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010797 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
10798 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010799
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010800 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010801 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010802 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
10803 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
10804 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010805 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010806 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
10807 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
10808 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
10809 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
10810 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
10811 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
10812 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
10813 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010814
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010815 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010816 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010817 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010818 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010819 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
10820 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
10821 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010822
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010823 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
10824 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
10825 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
10826 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010827
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010828 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
10829 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
10830 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
10831 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
10832 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010833 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
10834 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
10835 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
10836 layer7 information is extracted.
10837
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010838 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
10839 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
10840 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
10841 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
10842 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010843
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010844 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10845 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10846 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10847 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10848
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010849 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10850 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10851 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10852 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10853
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010854 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
10855 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
10856 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
10857 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
10858 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010859
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010860 - set-src <expr> :
10861 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
10862 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
10863 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010864 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010865
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010866 Arguments:
10867 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10868 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010869
10870 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010871 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
10872
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010873 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
10874 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010875
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010876 - set-src-port <expr> :
10877 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
10878 expression.
10879
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010880 Arguments:
10881 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10882 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010883
10884 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010885 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
10886
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010887 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
10888 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
10889 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010890
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010891 - set-dst <expr> :
10892 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
10893 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
10894 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
10895 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10896 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10897
10898 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10899 followed by some converters.
10900
10901 Example:
10902
10903 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
10904 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
10905
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010906 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
10907 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
10908
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010909 - set-dst-port <expr> :
10910 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
10911 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10912 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10913
10914
10915 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10916 followed by some converters.
10917
10918 Example:
10919
10920 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
10921
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010922 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
10923 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
10924 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
10925
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010926 - "silent-drop" :
10927 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010928 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010929 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10930 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10931 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10932 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10933 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010934 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10935 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010936 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10937 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010938 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010939 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10940 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10941 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10942 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10943
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010944 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10945 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10946 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010947
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010948 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10949 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
10950 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010951
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010952 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010953 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010954 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010955
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010956 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
10957 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10958 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010959
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010960 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010961 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10962 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010963
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010964 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
10965
10966 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10967
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010968 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10969
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010970 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010971
10972
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010973tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10974 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010976 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010977 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010978 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10979 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010980
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010981 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010982
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010983 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010984 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10985 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
10986 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
10987 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010988
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010989 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
10990 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
10991 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
10992 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010993 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
10994 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
10995 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
10996 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
10997 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
10998 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010999 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011000 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011001
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011002 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11003 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11004 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11005 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011006
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011007 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011008 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011009 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011010 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11011 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011012 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011013 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011014 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011015 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011016 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011017 - set-dst <expr>
11018 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011019 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011020 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011021 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011022 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011023 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011024
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011025 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
11026 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011027 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
11028 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011029
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011030 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
11031 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
11032 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
11033 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
11034 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
11035 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011036
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011037 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011038 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11039 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011040
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011041 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020011042 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
11043 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
11044 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
11045 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011046 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
11047 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
11048 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011049
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011050 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011051 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
11052 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
11053 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011054
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011055 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
11056 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
11057
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011058 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011059 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
11060 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011061
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011062 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11063 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011064 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011065 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11066 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011067 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011068 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011069 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011070 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11071 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011072 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011073 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11074 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011075
11076 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11077 followed by some converters.
11078
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011079 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11080 <var-name>.
11081
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011082 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
11083 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
11084 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
11085 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
11086 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
11087
11088 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
11089 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
11090 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
11091 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
11092 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
11093 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
11094 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
11095 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
11096 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
11097 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
11098 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
11099
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011100 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11101 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11102 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11103 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11104 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11105
11106 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11107
11108 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11109
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011110 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
11111 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
11112 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
11113 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
11114 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
11115 evaluated.
11116
11117 Example:
11118 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
11119
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011120 Example:
11121
11122 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011123 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011124
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011125 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011126 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
11127 # and reject everything else.
11128 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
11129 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020011130 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011131 tcp-request content reject
11132
11133 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011134 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
11135 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11136 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011137 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011138
11139 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
11140 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11141 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011142 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011143 tcp-request content reject
11144
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011145 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011146 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011147 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011148 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011149 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
11150 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011151
11152 Example:
11153 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11154 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011155 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011156
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011157 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011158 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011159
11160 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011161 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011162 # protecting all our sites
11163 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011164 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11165 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011166 ...
11167 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
11168
11169 backend http_dynamic
11170 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011171 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011172 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011173 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011174 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011175 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011176 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011177
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011178 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011179
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030011180 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
11181 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011182
11183
11184tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
11185 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
11186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011187 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011188 Arguments :
11189 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11190 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11191 as explained at the top of this document.
11192
11193 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
11194 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
11195 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
11196 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
11197 data for at most the specified amount of time.
11198
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011199 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
11200 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
11201 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
11202 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
11203
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011204 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
11205 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011206 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011207 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010011208 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
11209 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
11210 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
11211 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011212
11213 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
11214 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
11215 it pass through unaffected.
11216
11217 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
11218 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
11219 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011220 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011221 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
11222 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020011223 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
11224 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
11225 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011226
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011227 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011228 "timeout client".
11229
11230
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011231tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11232 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
11233 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11234 no | no | yes | yes
11235 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011236 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11237 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011238
11239 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11240
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011241 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011242 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11243 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011244 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
11245 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011246
11247 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
11248
11249 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11250 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11251 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11252 inserted.
11253
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011254 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011255 - accept :
11256 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11257 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11258 the rules evaluation.
11259
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011260 - close :
11261 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
11262 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
11263 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
11264 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
11265 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
11266 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011267 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011268 protocols.
11269
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011270 - reject :
11271 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11272 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011273 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011274
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011275 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
11276 Sets a variable.
11277
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011278 - unset-var(<var-name>)
11279 Unsets a variable.
11280
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011281 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11282 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11283 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11284 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11285
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011286 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11287 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11288 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11289 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11290
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011291 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
11292 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11293 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11294 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11295 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011296
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011297 - "silent-drop" :
11298 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011299 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011300 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11301 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11302 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11303 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11304 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011305 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11306 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011307 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11308 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011309 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011310 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11311 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11312 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11313 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11314
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011315 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
11316 Send a group of SPOE messages.
11317
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011318 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11319 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11320 for changing the default action to a reject.
11321
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011322 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
11323 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
11324 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
11325 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011326 period.
11327
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011328 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
11329 declared inline.
11330
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011331 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11332 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011333 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011334 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11335 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011336 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011337 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011338 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011339 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11340 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011341 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011342 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11343 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011344
11345 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11346 followed by some converters.
11347
11348 Example:
11349
11350 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
11351
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011352 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11353 <var-name>.
11354
11355 Example:
11356
11357 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
11358
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011359 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11360 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11361 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11362 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11363 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11364
11365 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11366
11367 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11368
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011369 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11370
11371 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
11372
11373
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011374tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11375 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
11376 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11377 no | yes | yes | no
11378 Arguments :
11379 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11380 below.
11381
11382 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11383
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011384 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011385 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
11386 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
11387 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
11388 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
11389 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
11390 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
11391 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011392 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011393 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
11394 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
11395 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
11396 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
11397 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
11398 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
11399 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
11400 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
11401 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
11402 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
11403 instead.
11404
11405 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11406 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11407 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
11408 rules which may be inserted.
11409
11410 Several types of actions are supported :
11411 - accept : the request is accepted
11412 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11413 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
11414 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011415 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011416 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011417 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011418 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011419 - silent-drop
11420
11421 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
11422 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
11423 sections for a complete description.
11424
11425 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11426 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11427 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
11428
11429 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
11430 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
11431 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
11432 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
11433 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
11434
11435 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11436 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11437
11438 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11439 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
11440 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
11441
11442 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11443 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
11444 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11445
11446 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
11447 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11448 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
11449
11450 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11451 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11452 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
11453
11454 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11455
11456 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
11457
11458
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011459tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
11460 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
11461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11462 no | no | yes | yes
11463 Arguments :
11464 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11465 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11466 as explained at the top of this document.
11467
11468 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
11469
11470
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011471timeout check <timeout>
11472 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
11473 established.
11474
11475 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11476 yes | no | yes | yes
11477 Arguments:
11478 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11479 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11480 as explained at the top of this document.
11481
11482 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
11483 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011484 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011485 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010011486 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
11487 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
11488 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011489
11490 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
11491 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
11492
11493 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
11494 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011495 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011496
11497 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11498 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11499 forget about it.
11500
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011501 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
11502 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011503
11504
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011505timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011506 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
11507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11508 yes | yes | yes | no
11509 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011510 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011511 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11512 as explained at the top of this document.
11513
11514 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11515 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11516 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010011517 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
11518 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
11519 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
11520 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011521 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
11522 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
11523 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011524 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011525 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011526 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
11527 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011528 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
11529 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011530
11531 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11532 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11533 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11534 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011535 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011536 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11537
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011538 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011539
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011540 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011541
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011542
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011543timeout client-fin <timeout>
11544 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
11545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11546 yes | yes | yes | no
11547 Arguments :
11548 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11549 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11550 as explained at the top of this document.
11551
11552 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11553 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11554 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11555 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11556 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
11557 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11558 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010011559 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
11560 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
11561 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011562
11563 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11564 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11565 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
11566
11567 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
11568
11569
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011570timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011571 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
11572 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11573 yes | no | yes | yes
11574 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011575 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011576 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11577 as explained at the top of this document.
11578
11579 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011580 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011581 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011582 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011583 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
11584 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011585
11586 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11587 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11588 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11589 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011590 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011591 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11592
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011593 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011594
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011595
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011596timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
11597 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
11598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11599 yes | yes | yes | yes
11600 Arguments :
11601 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11602 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11603 as explained at the top of this document.
11604
11605 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
11606 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
11607 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
11608 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
11609 once the request has started to present itself.
11610
11611 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
11612 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
11613 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
11614 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
11615 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
11616
11617 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
11618 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
11619 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
11620 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
11621
11622 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
11623 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011624 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011625 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
11626 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011627 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011628
11629 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
11630 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
11631 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
11632 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
11633
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011634 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
11635 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011636 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
11637
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011638 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
11639
11640
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011641timeout http-request <timeout>
11642 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
11643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011644 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011645 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011646 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011647 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11648 as explained at the top of this document.
11649
11650 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
11651 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
11652 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
11653 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
11654 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
11655 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
11656 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020011657 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
11658 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
11659 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
11660 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011661 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011662 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
11663 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011664
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011665 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
11666 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
11667 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
11668 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
11669 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011670 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011671
11672 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
11673 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011674 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011675 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
11676 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
11677
11678 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011679 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
11680 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
11681 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011682
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011683 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011684 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011685
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011686
11687timeout queue <timeout>
11688 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
11689 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11690 yes | no | yes | yes
11691 Arguments :
11692 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11693 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11694 as explained at the top of this document.
11695
11696 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
11697 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
11698 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
11699 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
11700 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
11701
11702 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
11703 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
11704 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
11705 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
11706
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011707 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011708
11709
11710timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011711 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
11712 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11713 yes | no | yes | yes
11714 Arguments :
11715 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11716 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11717 as explained at the top of this document.
11718
11719 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11720 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11721 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
11722 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
11723 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
11724 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
11725 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
11726
11727 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11728 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11729 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
11730 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
11731 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011732 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011733 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011734 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
11735 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011736 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
11737 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011738
11739 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11740 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11741 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11742 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011743 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011744 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11745
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011746 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011747
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011748
11749timeout server-fin <timeout>
11750 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
11751 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11752 yes | no | yes | yes
11753 Arguments :
11754 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11755 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11756 as explained at the top of this document.
11757
11758 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11759 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11760 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11761 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11762 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
11763 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11764 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
11765 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
11766 situations, it should not be needed.
11767
11768 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11769 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11770 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
11771
11772 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
11773
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011774
11775timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011776 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011777 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11778 yes | yes | yes | yes
11779 Arguments :
11780 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
11781 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11782 as explained at the top of this document.
11783
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020011784 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
11785 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
11786 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011787
11788 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11789 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11790 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
11791 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011792 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011793
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011794 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011795
11796
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011797timeout tunnel <timeout>
11798 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
11799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11800 yes | no | yes | yes
11801 Arguments :
11802 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11803 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11804 as explained at the top of this document.
11805
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011806 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011807 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
11808 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
11809 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011810 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
11811 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011812 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
11813 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
11814 specified.
11815
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011816 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
11817 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
11818 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
11819 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
11820 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
11821 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
11822 state.
11823
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011824 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11825 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11826 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
11827 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011828 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011829
11830 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11831 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11832 forget about it.
11833
11834 Example :
11835 defaults http
11836 option http-server-close
11837 timeout connect 5s
11838 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011839 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011840 timeout server 30s
11841 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
11842
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011843 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011844
11845
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011846transparent (deprecated)
11847 Enable client-side transparent proxying
11848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010011849 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011850 Arguments : none
11851
11852 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
11853 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
11854 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
11855 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
11856 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
11857 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
11858 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
11859 appropriate server.
11860
11861 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
11862
11863 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
11864 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
11865
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011866 See also: "option transparent"
11867
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011868unique-id-format <string>
11869 Generate a unique ID for each request.
11870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11871 yes | yes | yes | no
11872 Arguments :
11873 <string> is a log-format string.
11874
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011875 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
11876 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
11877 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
11878 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011879
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011880 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
11881 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
11882 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
11883 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
11884 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
11885 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
11886 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
11887 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011888
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011889 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
11890 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011891
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011892 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011893
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011894 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011895
11896 will generate:
11897
11898 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11899
11900 See also: "unique-id-header"
11901
11902unique-id-header <name>
11903 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
11904 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11905 yes | yes | yes | no
11906 Arguments :
11907 <name> is the name of the header.
11908
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011909 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
11910 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011911
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011912 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011913
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011914 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011915 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
11916
11917 will generate:
11918
11919 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11920
11921 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011922
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011923use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011924 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011925 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11926 no | yes | yes | no
11927 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011928 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
11929 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011930
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011931 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
11932 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011933
11934 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
11935 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
11936 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011937 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011938 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011939 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
11940 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011941
11942 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
11943 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
11944 assign the backend.
11945
11946 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
11947 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11948 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
11949 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
11950 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
11951 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
11952
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011953 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011954 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011955 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
11956 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
11957 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
11958
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011959 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
11960 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
11961 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
11962 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
11963 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
11964 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
11965 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
11966 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
11967 cannot be forced from the request.
11968
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011969 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011970 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
11971 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
11972
11973 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
11974 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011975
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020011976use-fcgi-app <name>
11977 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
11978 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11979 no | no | yes | yes
11980 Arguments :
11981 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
11982
11983 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011984
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011985use-server <server> if <condition>
11986use-server <server> unless <condition>
11987 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
11988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11989 no | no | yes | yes
11990 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020011991 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
11992 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011993
11994 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
11995
11996 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
11997 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
11998 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
11999
12000 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
12001 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
12002 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
12003 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
12004 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
12005 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
12006 matches will assign the server.
12007
12008 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
12009 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
12010 with the next rules until one matches.
12011
12012 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
12013 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12014 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
12015 according to other persistence mechanisms.
12016
12017 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
12018 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
12019 stripped.
12020
12021 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
12022 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
12023 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
12024 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
12025
12026 Example :
12027 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
12028 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
12029 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
12030 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
12031 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
12032 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000012033 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012034 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
12035 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
12036
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012037 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
12038 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
12039 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
12040 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050012041 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012042 and we fall back to load balancing.
12043
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012044 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012045
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012046
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100120475. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012048--------------------------
12049
12050The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
12051depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
12052settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
12053written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
12054described in this section.
12055
12056
120575.1. Bind options
12058-----------------
12059
12060The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
12061as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
12062no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
12063parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
12064while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
12065provided immediately after the setting name.
12066
12067The currently supported settings are the following ones.
12068
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012069accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
12070 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
12071 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
12072 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
12073 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
12074 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
12075 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
12076 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
12077 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
12078 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012079 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
12080 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
12081 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012082
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012083accept-proxy
12084 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020012085 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
12086 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012087 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
12088 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
12089 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
12090 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012091 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012092 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
12093 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012094 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
12095 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012096
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012097allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010012098 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012099 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012100 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012101 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
12102 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012103
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012104alpn <protocols>
12105 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12106 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12107 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012108 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012109 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012110 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
12111 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12112 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
12113 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
12114 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
12115 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
12116 preference, like below :
12117
12118 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012119
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012120backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010012121 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012122 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
12123
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010012124curves <curves>
12125 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12126 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
12127 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
12128 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
12129 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
12130 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
12131
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012132ecdhe <named curve>
12133 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010012134 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
12135 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012136
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012137ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012138 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12139 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12140 client's certificate.
12141
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012142ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
12143 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12144 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
12145 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
12146 error is ignored.
12147
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012148ca-sign-file <cafile>
12149 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12150 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
12151 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
12152 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12153 'generate-certificates' for details.
12154
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000012155ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012156 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
12157 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
12158 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12159 'generate-certificates' for details.
12160
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012161ca-verify-file <cafile>
12162 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
12163 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
12164 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
12165 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
12166 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
12167
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012168ciphers <ciphers>
12169 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12170 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000012171 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012172 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012173 information and recommendations see e.g.
12174 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12175 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12176 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
12177
12178ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12179 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12180 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
12181 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
12182 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012183 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
12184 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012185
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012186crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012187 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12188 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12189 to verify client's certificate.
12190
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012191crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012192 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12193 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
12194 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
12195 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
12196 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010012197 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
12198 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012199
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010012200 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
12201 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
12202
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012203 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
12204 are loaded.
12205
12206 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010012207 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
12208 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
12209 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
12210 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
12211 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
12212 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
12213 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012214 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012215
12216 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
12217 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
12218 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
12219 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010012220 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
12221 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012222
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020012223 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012224
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012225 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012226 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012227 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
12228 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012229 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
12230 clients).
12231
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020012232 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
12233 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
12234 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
12235 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
12236 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
12237 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
12238 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
12239 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
12240 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
12241 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
12242 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
12243 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
12244 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
12245
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012246 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
12247 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
12248 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
12249 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
12250 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
12251
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012252 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
12253 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
12254 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
12255 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012256
12257 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
12258 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
12259 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
12260 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
12261 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
12262 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
12263 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
12264 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
12265 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
12266
12267 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
12268
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012269 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012270 a cert bundle.
12271
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012272 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012273 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
12274 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
12275 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
12276 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
12277 provide multi-cert support.
12278
12279 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
12280
12281 Filename | CN | SAN
12282 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
12283 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012284 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012285 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
12286 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
12287
12288 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
12289 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
12290 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
12291 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020012292 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
12293 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
12294 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012295
12296 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
12297 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
12298
12299 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
12300 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
12301 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
12302
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012303crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012304 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012305 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012306 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012307 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012308
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012309crt-list <file>
12310 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012311 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
12312 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012313
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012314 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
12315
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020012316 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
12317 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
12318 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
12319 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
12320 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012321
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020012322 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
12323 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
12324 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
12325 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
12326 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
12327 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
12328 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
12329 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012330
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012331 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020012332 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020012333 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
12334 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
12335 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012336
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012337 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
12338
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012339 crt-list file example:
12340 cert1.pem
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012341 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012342 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012343 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012344 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012345
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012346defer-accept
12347 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12348 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
12349 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012350 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012351 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
12352 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
12353 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
12354 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
12355 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
12356 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
12357 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
12358
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012359expose-fd listeners
12360 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
12361 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020012362 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
12363 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012364 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012365
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012366force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012367 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012368 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012369 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012370 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012371
12372force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012373 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012374 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012375 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012376
12377force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012378 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012379 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012380 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012381
12382force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012383 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012384 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012385 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012386
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012387force-tlsv13
12388 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
12389 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012390 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012391
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012392generate-certificates
12393 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12394 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
12395 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
12396 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
12397 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
12398 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
12399 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
12400 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
12401 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
12402 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
12403 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
12404
12405 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
12406 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012407 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012408 certificate is used many times.
12409
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012410gid <gid>
12411 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
12412 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12413 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
12414 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
12415 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12416
12417group <group>
12418 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
12419 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
12420 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
12421 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
12422 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12423
12424id <id>
12425 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
12426 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
12427 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
12428 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
12429
12430interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010012431 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
12432 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
12433 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
12434 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
12435 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
12436 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010012437 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
12438 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
12439 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
12440 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
12441 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
12442 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012443
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012444level <level>
12445 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
12446 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
12447 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012448 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012449 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
12450 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
12451 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012452 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012453 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012454 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012455 all counters).
12456
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020012457severity-output <format>
12458 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
12459 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
12460 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
12461 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
12462 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
12463 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
12464 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
12465 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
12466 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
12467 rfc5424 convention.
12468
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012469maxconn <maxconn>
12470 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
12471 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
12472 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
12473 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
12474 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
12475 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
12476 eat all memory.
12477
12478mode <mode>
12479 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
12480 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
12481 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
12482 UNIX sockets.
12483
12484mss <maxseg>
12485 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
12486 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
12487 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
12488 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
12489 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
12490 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
12491 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
12492 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
12493 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
12494 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
12495 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
12496
12497name <name>
12498 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
12499 page.
12500
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012501namespace <name>
12502 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12503 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
12504 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12505 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12506
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012507nice <nice>
12508 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
12509 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
12510 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
12511 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
12512 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
12513 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
12514 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
12515 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
12516 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
12517 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
12518 one for an RDP socket.
12519
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012520no-ca-names
12521 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12522 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012523 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012524
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012525no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012526 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012527 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012528 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012529 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012530 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
12531 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012532
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012533no-tls-tickets
12534 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12535 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12536 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012537 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
12538 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012539 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12540 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12541 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012542
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012543no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012544 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012545 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012546 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012547 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012548 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12549 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012550
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012551no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012552 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012553 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012554 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012555 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012556 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12557 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012558
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012559no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012560 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012561 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012562 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012563 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012564 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12565 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012566
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012567no-tlsv13
12568 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12569 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
12570 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
12571 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012572 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12573 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012574
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012575npn <protocols>
12576 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12577 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12578 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012579 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012580 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012581 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12582 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
12583 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
12584 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
12585 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012586
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012587prefer-client-ciphers
12588 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
12589 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
12590 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020012591 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
12592 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
12593 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012594
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012595process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012596 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012597 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012598 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012599 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
12600 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
12601 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
12602 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012603 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012604 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
12605 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
12606 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
12607 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
12608 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012609
12610 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
12611
12612 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
12613 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
12614 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
12615 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
12616 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
12617 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
12618 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
12619 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020012620
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012621proto <name>
12622 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
12623 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
12624 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
12625 in haproxy -vv.
12626 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12627 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080012628 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012629 h2" on the bind line.
12630
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012631ssl
12632 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012633 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012634 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
12635 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020012636 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
12637 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012638
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012639ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12640 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020012641 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
12642 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
12643 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012644 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12645
12646ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020012647 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
12648 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
12649 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
12650 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012651
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010012652strict-sni
12653 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
12654 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
12655 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
12656 See the "crt" option for more information.
12657
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012658tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012659 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012660 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
12661 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012662 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012663 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
12664 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
12665 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
12666 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
12667 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
12668 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
12669 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12670
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012671tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010012672 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012673 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
12674 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
12675 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
12676 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
12677 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
12678 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
12679 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020012680 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
12681 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
12682 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012683
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012684tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
12685 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010012686 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
12687 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
12688 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
12689 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
12690 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
12691 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
12692 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
12693 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
12694 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
12695 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012696 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
12697 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
12698
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012699transparent
12700 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12701 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
12702 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
12703 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
12704 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
12705 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
12706 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
12707 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
12708 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
12709 so check for support with your vendor.
12710
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012711v4v6
12712 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12713 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
12714 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
12715 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012716 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012717
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012718v6only
12719 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12720 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
12721 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012722 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
12723 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012724
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012725uid <uid>
12726 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
12727 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12728 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
12729 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
12730 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12731
12732user <user>
12733 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
12734 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12735 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
12736 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
12737 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12738
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012739verify [none|optional|required]
12740 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
12741 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
12742 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
12743 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
12744 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012745 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
12746 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
12747 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
12748 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012749
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200127505.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012751------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012752
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012753The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
12754which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
12755arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
12756settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
12757after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
12758Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
12759address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012760
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012761 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012762 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012763
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012764Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
12765keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
12766
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012767The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012768
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012769addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012770 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010012771 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
12772 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
12773 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
12774 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
12775 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012776
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012777agent-check
12778 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012779 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010012780 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
12781 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
12782 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012783
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012784 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012785 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020012786 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
12787 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
12788 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012789
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012790 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
12791 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
12792 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
12793 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
12794 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020012795
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012796 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012797 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012798
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012799 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12800 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
12801 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012802
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012803 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12804 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
12805 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012806
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012807 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
12808 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
12809 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
12810 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
12811 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012812 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012813 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012814
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012815 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
12816 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012817
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012818 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
12819 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
12820 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
12821 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
12822 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
12823 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
12824 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
12825 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
12826 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012827
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012828 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
12829 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012830 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
12831 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
12832 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010012833 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012834
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012835 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012836 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012837
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070012838agent-send <string>
12839 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
12840 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
12841 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
12842 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
12843 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
12844
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012845agent-inter <delay>
12846 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
12847 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12848
12849 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
12850 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
12851 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
12852 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
12853 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12854 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12855 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12856 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12857 of backends use the same servers.
12858
12859 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
12860
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010012861agent-addr <addr>
12862 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
12863
12864 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
12865 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
12866 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
12867 hostname, it will be resolved.
12868
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012869agent-port <port>
12870 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
12871
12872 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
12873
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012874allow-0rtt
12875 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020012876 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
12877 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012878
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012879alpn <protocols>
12880 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12881 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12882 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012883 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012884 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
12885 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
12886 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12887 now obsolete NPN extension.
12888 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
12889 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
12890
12891 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
12892
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012893backup
12894 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
12895 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
12896 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
12897 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012898 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
12899 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012900
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012901ca-file <cafile>
12902 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12903 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12904 server's certificate.
12905
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012906check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020012907 This option enables health checks on a server:
12908 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
12909 considered available.
12910 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
12911 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
12912 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
12913 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
12914 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
12915 set.
12916 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
12917 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
12918 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
12919 exchanges succeed.
12920
12921 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
12922 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
12923 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
12924 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
12925 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050012926 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020012927 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
12928
12929 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
12930 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
12931
12932 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
12933 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
12934
12935 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
12936 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
12937 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
12938 available.
12939
12940 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
12941 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
12942 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
12943
12944 Example:
12945 # simple tcp check
12946 backend foo
12947 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
12948 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
12949 backend foo
12950 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
12951 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
12952 backend foo
12953 option tcp-check
12954 tcp-check connect
12955 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012956
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020012957check-send-proxy
12958 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
12959 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
12960 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
12961 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
12962 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
12963 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
12964 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
12965
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010012966check-alpn <protocols>
12967 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
12968 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
12969 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12970
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020012971check-proto <name>
12972 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
12973 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
12974 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
12975 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv.
12976 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12977 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
12978 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
12979
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012980check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012981 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012982 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
12983 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012984
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012985check-ssl
12986 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
12987 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
12988 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
12989 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012990 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012991 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
12992 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012993 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012994 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
12995 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012996
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012997check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012998 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012999 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
13000 for normal traffic.
13001
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013002ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013003 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
13004 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
13005 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013006 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
13007 information and recommendations see e.g.
13008 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13009 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13010 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013011
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013012ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13013 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13014 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
13015 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
13016 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013017 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
13018 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
13019 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013020
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013021cookie <value>
13022 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
13023 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
13024 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
13025 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
13026 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
13027 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
13028 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
13029
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013030crl-file <crlfile>
13031 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13032 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13033 to verify server's certificate.
13034
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020013035crt <cert>
13036 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13037 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
13038 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
13039 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
13040 certificate request.
13041
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013042disabled
13043 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
13044 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
13045 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
13046 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
13047 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013048 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013049
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013050enabled
13051 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
13052 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
13053 default value.
13054 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
13055 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013056
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013057error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010013058 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
13059 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
13060 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013061
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013062 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013063
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013064fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013065 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
13066 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
13067 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
13068
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013069force-sslv3
13070 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13071 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013072 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013073 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013074
13075force-tlsv10
13076 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013077 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013078 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013079
13080force-tlsv11
13081 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013082 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013083 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013084
13085force-tlsv12
13086 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013087 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013088 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013089
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013090force-tlsv13
13091 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13092 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013093 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013094
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013095id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020013096 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
13097 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
13098 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013099
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013100init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
13101 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
13102 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013103 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013104 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
13105 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
13106 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
13107 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
13108 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
13109 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
13110 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
13111 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
13112 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013113 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013114 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
13115 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
13116 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
13117 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
13118 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
13119 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013120 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013121
13122 Example:
13123 defaults
13124 # never fail on address resolution
13125 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
13126
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013127inter <delay>
13128fastinter <delay>
13129downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013130 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
13131 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13132 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
13133 between checks depending on the server state :
13134
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020013135 Server state | Interval used
13136 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13137 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
13138 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13139 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
13140 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
13141 or yet unchecked. |
13142 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13143 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
13144 | "inter" otherwise.
13145 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013146
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013147 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
13148 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
13149 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
13150 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013151 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13152 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13153 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13154 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13155 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013156
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020013157log-proto <logproto>
13158 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
13159 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
13160 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
13161 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
13162
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013163maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013164 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
13165 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013166 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
13167 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013168 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
13169 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
13170 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
13171 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
13172
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013173 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
13174 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
13175 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
13176 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
13177 than 50 concurrent requests.
13178
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013179maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013180 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
13181 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
13182 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
13183 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
13184 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
13185 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
13186 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
13187
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010013188max-reuse <count>
13189 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
13190 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
13191 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
13192 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
13193 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
13194 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
13195 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
13196 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
13197
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013198minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013199 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
13200 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
13201 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
13202 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
13203 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
13204 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013205 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013206 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013207
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013208namespace <name>
13209 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13210 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
13211 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13212 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13213
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013214no-agent-check
13215 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
13216 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13217 default value.
13218 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13219 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
13220
13221no-backup
13222 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
13223 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13224 default value.
13225 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13226 "default-server" "backup" setting.
13227
13228no-check
13229 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
13230 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13231 default value.
13232 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13233 "default-server" "check" setting.
13234
13235no-check-ssl
13236 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
13237 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13238 default value.
13239 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13240 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
13241
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013242no-send-proxy
13243 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
13244 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13245 default value.
13246 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13247 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
13248
13249no-send-proxy-v2
13250 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
13251 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13252 default value.
13253 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13254 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
13255
13256no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
13257 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
13258 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13259 default value.
13260 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13261 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
13262
13263no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13264 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
13265 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13266 default value.
13267 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13268 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
13269
13270no-ssl
13271 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
13272 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13273 default value.
13274 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13275 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
13276
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010013277no-ssl-reuse
13278 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
13279 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
13280 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
13281 and for paranoid users.
13282
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013283no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013284 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13285 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013286 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013287
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013288 Supported in default-server: No
13289
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013290no-tls-tickets
13291 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13292 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13293 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013294 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
13295 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013296 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13297 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13298 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013299 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013300
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013301no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013302 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013303 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13304 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013305 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13306 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013307 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013308
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013309 Supported in default-server: No
13310
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013311no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013312 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013313 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13314 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013315 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13316 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013317 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013318
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013319 Supported in default-server: No
13320
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013321no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013322 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013323 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13324 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013325 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13326 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013327 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013328
13329 Supported in default-server: No
13330
13331no-tlsv13
13332 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13333 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13334 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
13335 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13336 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013337 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013338
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013339 Supported in default-server: No
13340
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013341no-verifyhost
13342 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
13343 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13344 default value.
13345 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13346 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013347
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013348no-tfo
13349 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
13350 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13351 default value.
13352 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13353 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
13354
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090013355non-stick
13356 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
13357 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
13358 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
13359
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013360npn <protocols>
13361 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13362 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13363 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013364 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013365 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
13366 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13367 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
13368
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013369observe <mode>
13370 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
13371 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
13372 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
13373 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
13374 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
13375 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010013376 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013377
13378 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
13379
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013380on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013381 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
13382 Currently, four modes are available:
13383 - fastinter: force fastinter
13384 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
13385 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
13386 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
13387 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
13388
13389 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
13390
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013391on-marked-down <action>
13392 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
13393 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013394 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
13395 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
13396 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
13397 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
13398 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
13399 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
13400 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
13401 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013402
13403 Actions are disabled by default
13404
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013405on-marked-up <action>
13406 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
13407 Currently one action is available:
13408 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
13409 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
13410 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
13411 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013412 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
13413 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013414 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
13415 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
13416
13417 Actions are disabled by default
13418
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020013419pool-low-conn <max>
13420 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
13421 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
13422 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
13423 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
13424 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
13425 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
13426 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
13427 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
13428 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
13429 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
13430 applying to "http-reuse".
13431
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010013432pool-max-conn <max>
13433 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
13434 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
13435 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
13436 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
13437 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
13438 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
13439
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013440pool-purge-delay <delay>
13441 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010013442 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020013443 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013444
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013445port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013446 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
13447 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
13448 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
13449 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
13450 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
13451 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
13452
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013453proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013454 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
13455 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
13456 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
13457 reported in haproxy -vv.
13458 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
13459 protocol for all connections established to this server.
13460
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013461redir <prefix>
13462 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
13463 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
13464 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
13465 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
13466 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
13467 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
13468 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
13469 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013470 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013471 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013472 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
13473 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
13474 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
13475 loop between the client and HAProxy!
13476
13477 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
13478
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013479rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013480 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
13481 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
13482 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
13483
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013484resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
13485 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
13486 server.
13487
13488 Available options:
13489
13490 * allow-dup-ip
13491 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
13492 resolution at runtime is in operation.
13493 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
13494 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
13495 For such case, simply enable this option.
13496 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
13497
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050013498 * ignore-weight
13499 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
13500 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
13501 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
13502
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013503 * prevent-dup-ip
13504 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
13505 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
13506 same fqdn.
13507 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
13508
13509 Example:
13510 backend b_myapp
13511 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
13512 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13513 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13514
13515 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
13516 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
13517 it
13518 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
13519 different address
13520
13521 Default value: not set
13522
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013523resolve-prefer <family>
13524 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
13525 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
13526 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
13527 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
13528
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020013529 Default value: ipv6
13530
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013531 Example:
13532
13533 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013534
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013535resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013536 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013537 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013538 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013539 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
13540 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013541 configured network, another address is selected.
13542
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013543 Example:
13544
13545 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013546
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013547resolvers <id>
13548 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
13549 hostname.
13550
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013551 Example:
13552
13553 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013554
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013555 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013556
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013557send-proxy
13558 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
13559 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
13560 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
13561 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013562 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
13563 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
13564 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
13565 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
13566 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
13567 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
13568 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
13569 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
13570 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
13571 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013572 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
13573 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013574
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013575send-proxy-v2
13576 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
13577 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13578 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13579 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020013580 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
13581 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
13582 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
13583 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013584
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013585proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010013586 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
13587 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
13588
13589 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
13590 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
13591 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
13592 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
13593 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
13594 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
13595 connection is supported).
13596 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
13597 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
13598 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
13599 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
13600 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
13601 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
13602 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013603
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013604send-proxy-v2-ssl
13605 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13606 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13607 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13608 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13609 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13610 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
13611 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013612 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
13613 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013614
13615send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13616 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13617 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13618 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13619 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13620 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13621 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
13622 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
13623 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013624 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
13625 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013626
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013627slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013628 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
13629 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
13630 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
13631 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
13632 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
13633 parameters :
13634
13635 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
13636 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
13637
13638 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
13639 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
13640 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
13641 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
13642
13643 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
13644 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
13645 seen as failed.
13646
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013647sni <expression>
13648 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
13649 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
13650 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
13651 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020013652 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
13653 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013654 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010013655 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
13656 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013657
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013658source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020013659source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013660source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013661 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
13662 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
13663 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
13664 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
13665
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013666 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
13667 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
13668 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
13669 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
13670 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
13671 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
13672 server.
13673
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000013674 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
13675 specifying the source address without port(s).
13676
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013677ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020013678 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
13679 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
13680 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
13681 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
13682 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
13683 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013684 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
13685 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013686
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013687ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13688 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
13689 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13690 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13691
13692ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13693 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
13694 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13695 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
13696
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013697ssl-reuse
13698 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
13699 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13700 default value.
13701 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13702 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
13703
13704stick
13705 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
13706 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13707 default value.
13708 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13709 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013710
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013711socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013712 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013713 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
13714 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
13715
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013716tcp-ut <delay>
13717 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
13718 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
13719 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013720 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013721 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
13722 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
13723 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
13724 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
13725 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
13726 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
13727 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
13728 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
13729 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13730
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010013731tfo
13732 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
13733 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
13734 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
13735 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
13736 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013737 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010013738
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013739track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020013740 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
13741 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
13742 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
13743 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013744 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
13745
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013746tls-tickets
13747 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
13748 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13749 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013750 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13751 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13752 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013753 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010013754 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013755
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013756verify [none|required]
13757 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010013758 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013759 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
13760 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013761 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013762 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
13763 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
13764 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
13765 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
13766 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
13767 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
13768 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
13769 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013770
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070013771verifyhost <hostname>
13772 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013773 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
13774 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
13775 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
13776 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
13777 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
13778 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
13779 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
13780 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070013781
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013782weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013783 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
13784 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
13785 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020013786 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
13787 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
13788 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
13789 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
13790 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
13791 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013792
13793
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200137945.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
13795-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013796
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013797HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
13798using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
13799configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013800This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
13801can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
13802workload.
13803This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
13804resolution at run time.
13805Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
13806carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
13807
13808
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200138095.3.1. Global overview
13810----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013811
13812As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
13813different steps of the process life:
13814
13815 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
13816 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
13817 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
13818
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013819 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
13820 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013821
13822A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
13823 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
13824 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
13825 resolution to know this new IP.
13826
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013827When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013828HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013829SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
13830from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
13831will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
13832will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020013833
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013834A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013835 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013836 first valid response.
13837
13838 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
13839 servers return an error.
13840
13841
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200138425.3.2. The resolvers section
13843----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013844
13845This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013846HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
13847contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013848
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013849When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
13850uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
13851is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
13852answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
13853
13854When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013855used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013856
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013857 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
13858 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
13859 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013860
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013861 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
13862 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013863
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013864 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
13865 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
13866 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013867
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013868For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
13869following scenarios are possible:
13870
13871 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
13872 ignored
13873
13874 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
13875 applied
13876
13877 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
13878 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
13879
13880 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
13881 retries the query with a new type
13882
13883 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
13884 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013885
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013886As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
13887a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013888<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013889
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013890
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013891resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013892 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013893
13894A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
13895
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013896accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013897 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013898 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013899 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
13900 by RFC 6891)
13901
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020013902 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
13903
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013904nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
13905 DNS server description:
13906 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
13907 <ip> : IP address of the server
13908 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
13909
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013910parse-resolv-conf
13911 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
13912 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
13913 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
13914
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013915hold <status> <period>
13916 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
13917 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013918 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013919 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013920 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
13921 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13922 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
13923
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020013924 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013925
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013926resolve_retries <nb>
13927 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
13928 giving up.
13929 Default value: 3
13930
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013931 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
13932 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
13933 type.
13934
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013935timeout <event> <time>
13936 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
13937 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
13938 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013939 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
13940 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013941 Default value: 1s
13942 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013943 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013944 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013945 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13946 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
13947
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013948 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013949
13950 resolvers mydns
13951 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
13952 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013953 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013954 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013955 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013956 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013957 hold other 30s
13958 hold refused 30s
13959 hold nx 30s
13960 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013961 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013962 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013963
13964
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200139656. Cache
13966---------
13967
13968HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
13969(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
13970RAM.
13971
13972The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
13973this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
13974
13975If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
13976independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
13977when we try to allocate a new one.
13978
13979The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
13980
13981It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
13982"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
13983for more details.
13984
13985When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
13986replaced by "<CACHE>".
13987
13988
139896.1. Limitation
13990----------------
13991
13992The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
13993
13994- If the response is not a 200
13995- If the response contains a Vary header
13996- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
13997- If the response is not cacheable
13998
13999- If the request is not a GET
14000- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
14001- If the request contains an Authorization header
14002
14003
140046.2. Setup
14005-----------
14006
14007To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
14008the corresponding http-request and response actions.
14009
14010
140116.2.1. Cache section
14012---------------------
14013
14014cache <name>
14015 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
14016 size of cache is mandatory.
14017
14018total-max-size <megabytes>
14019 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
14020 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
14021
14022max-object-size <bytes>
14023 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
14024 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
14025 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
14026
14027max-age <seconds>
14028 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
14029 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
14030 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
14031 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
14032 default.
14033
14034
140356.2.2. Proxy section
14036---------------------
14037
14038http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14039 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
14040 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
14041 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
14042 after this one.
14043
14044http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14045 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
14046 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
14047 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
14048 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
14049
14050
14051Example:
14052
14053 backend bck1
14054 mode http
14055
14056 http-request cache-use foobar
14057 http-response cache-store foobar
14058 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
14059
14060 cache foobar
14061 total-max-size 4
14062 max-age 240
14063
14064
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200140657. Using ACLs and fetching samples
14066----------------------------------
14067
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014068HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014069client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
14070The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
14071these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
14072but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
14073data called patterns.
14074
14075
140767.1. ACL basics
14077---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014078
14079The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
14080content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
14081from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
14082simple :
14083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014084 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014085 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014086 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
14087 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014089The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
14090adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014091
14092In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
14093
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014094 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014095
14096This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
14097Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
14098and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014099an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
14100conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
14101as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
14102are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014103
14104ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
14105'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
14106which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
14107
14108There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
14109performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
14110
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014111The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
14112specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
14113this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014114methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
14115ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014116
14117Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
14118 - boolean
14119 - integer (signed or unsigned)
14120 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
14121 - string
14122 - data block
14123
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014124Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
14125converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
14126would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
14127The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
14128which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
14129
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014130Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
14131keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
14132fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
14133which are summarized in the table below :
14134
14135 +---------------------+-----------------+
14136 | Sample or converter | Default |
14137 | output type | matching method |
14138 +---------------------+-----------------+
14139 | boolean | bool |
14140 +---------------------+-----------------+
14141 | integer | int |
14142 +---------------------+-----------------+
14143 | ip | ip |
14144 +---------------------+-----------------+
14145 | string | str |
14146 +---------------------+-----------------+
14147 | binary | none, use "-m" |
14148 +---------------------+-----------------+
14149
14150Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
14151matching method, see below.
14152
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014153The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
14154 - boolean
14155 - integer or integer range
14156 - IP address / network
14157 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
14158 - regular expression
14159 - hex block
14160
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014161The following ACL flags are currently supported :
14162
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014163 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
14164 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014165 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014166 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014167 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014168 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014169 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
14170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014171The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
14172read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
14173if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
14174lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
14175will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
14176beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
14177a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
14178lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
14179exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
14180
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014181The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
14182parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
14183ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
14184a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
14185check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
14186
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014187The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
14188socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
14189file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
14190
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014191Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
14192loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
14193
14194 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
14195
14196In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
14197the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
14198case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
14199as well.
14200
14201The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
14202sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
14203do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
14204methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
14205is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014206obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014207followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
14208default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
14209that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
14210string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
14211
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014212The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
14213By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
14214string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
14215resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
14216server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014217waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014218flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
14219function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
14220
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014221There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
14222sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
14223be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014224
14225 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
14226 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014227 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
14228 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
14229 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
14230 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014231
14232 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
14233 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014234 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014235
14236 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014237 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014238
14239 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014240 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014241
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014242 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014243 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
14244
14245 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
14246 binary or string samples.
14247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014248 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
14249 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014250
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014251 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
14252 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
14253 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014255 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
14256 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014258 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
14259 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014261 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
14262 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014264 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
14265 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014266 This may be used with binary or string samples.
14267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014268 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
14269 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
14270 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014271
14272For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
14273request, it is possible to do :
14274
14275 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
14276
14277In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
14278buffer, one would use the following acl :
14279
14280 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
14281
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014282On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
14283possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
14284
14285 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
14286
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014287All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
14288criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
14289method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
14290to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
14291criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
14292the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014294If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014295the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
14296For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014297
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014298 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
14299 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
14300 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
14301 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014302
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014303
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014304The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
14305types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
14306combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
14307brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
14308default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014310 +-------------------------------------------------+
14311 | Input sample type |
14312 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014313 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014314 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14315 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
14316 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014317 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014318 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014319 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014320 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014321 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014322 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014323 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014324 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014325 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014326 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014327 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014328 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014329 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014330 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014331 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014332 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014333 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014334 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014335 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014336 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014337 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014338 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14339 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
14340 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014341
14342
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200143437.1.1. Matching booleans
14344------------------------
14345
14346In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
14347Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
14348When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
14349that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
14350
14351Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
14352return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
14353"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
14354
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014355
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200143567.1.2. Matching integers
14357------------------------
14358
14359Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
14360enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
14361to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
14362
14363Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
14364matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
14365lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014366
14367For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
14368unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
14369representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
14370
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014371As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
14372two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
14373instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
14374ranges and operators.
14375
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014376For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014377operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
14378Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
14379of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014380
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014381Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014382
14383 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
14384 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
14385 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
14386 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
14387 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
14388
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014389For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014390
14391 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
14392
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014393This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
14394
14395 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
14396
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014397
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200143987.1.3. Matching strings
14399-----------------------
14400
14401String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
14402different forms :
14403
14404 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014405 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014406
14407 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014408 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014409
14410 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
14411 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14412
14413 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
14414 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14415
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010014416 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014417 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
14418 matches.
14419
14420 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
14421 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
14422 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014423
14424String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
14425exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
14426characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
14427string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
14428to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014429before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014430
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010014431Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
14432(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
14433Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
14434
14435Example:
14436 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
14437 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
14438
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200144407.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
14441---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014442
14443Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
14444they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
14445possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
14446passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
14447the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014448the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
14449match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014450
14451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200144527.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
14453-------------------------------------
14454
14455It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
14456not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
14457a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
14458to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
14459digits may be used upper or lower case.
14460
14461Example :
14462 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
14463 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
14464
14465
144667.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
14467---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014468
14469IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
14470netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
14471within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014472host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014473difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
14474at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
14475does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
14476parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014477
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020014478The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
14479abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
14480
14481 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14482 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
14483 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14484 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
14485 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
14486 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
14487 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
14488 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14489
14490Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
14491192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
14492
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014493IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
14494Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
14495trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
14496IPv6 patterns.
14497
14498HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
14499following situations :
14500 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
14501 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
14502 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
14503 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
14504 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
14505 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
14506 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
14507 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
14508 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
14509 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
14510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014511
145127.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
14513----------------------------------
14514
14515Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
14516combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
14517
14518 - AND (implicit)
14519 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
14520 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014521
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014522A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014524 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014526Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
14527indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014528
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014529For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
14530"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
14531requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
14532is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
14533
14534 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014535 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
14536 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
14537 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014538
14539To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
14540and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
14541
14542 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
14543 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
14544 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
14545 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
14546
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014547 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014548 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
14549 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
14550 use_backend www if host_www
14551
14552It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
14553expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
14554be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
14555the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
14556
14557 The following rule :
14558
14559 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014560 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014561
14562 Can also be written that way :
14563
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014564 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014565
14566It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
14567to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
14568simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
14569sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
14570good use is the following :
14571
14572 With named ACLs :
14573
14574 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
14575 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
14576 monitor fail if site_dead
14577
14578 With anonymous ACLs :
14579
14580 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
14581
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014582See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
14583keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014584
14585
145867.3. Fetching samples
14587---------------------
14588
14589Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
14590against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
14591sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
14592ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
14593of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
14594available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
14595
14596This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
14597Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
14598compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
14599deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
14600
14601The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
14602matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
14603method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
14604indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
14605
14606As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
14607when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
14608mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
14609the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
14610ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
14611
14612Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
14613multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
14614when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014615incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
14616are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014617is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
14618all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
14619
14620Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
14621 - name
14622 - name(arg1)
14623 - name(arg1,arg2)
14624
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014625
146267.3.1. Converters
14627-----------------
14628
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014629Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
14630of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
14631is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
14632was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014633has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014634unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
14635
14636These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
14637sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
14638the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014639support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014640
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014641A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
14642support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
14643supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
14644(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
14645bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
14646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014647The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014648
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001464951d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
14650 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
14651 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
14652 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
14653 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
14654 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
14655
14656 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014657 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
14658 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000014659 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
14660 frontend http-in
14661 bind *:8081
14662 default_backend servers
14663 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
14664 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
14665
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014666add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014667 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014668 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014669 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
14670 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014671 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014672 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14673 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14674 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14675 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014676 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014677 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014678
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010014679aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
14680 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
14681 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
14682 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
14683 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
14684 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
14685 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
14686
14687 Example:
14688 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
14689 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
14690
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014691and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014692 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014693 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014694 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14695 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014696 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014697 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14698 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14699 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14700 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014701 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014702 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014703
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020014704b64dec
14705 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
14706 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
14707
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014708base64
14709 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014710 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014711 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
14712
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014713bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014714 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014715 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014716 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014717 presence of a flag).
14718
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014719bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
14720 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
14721 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014722 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014723
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014724concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
14725 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
14726 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
14727 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
14728 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
14729 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
14730 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
14731 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
14732 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
14733 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
14734 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014735 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
14736 parethesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
14737 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
14738 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014739
14740 Example:
14741 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
14742 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
14743 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014744 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014745 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
14746
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014747cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014748 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
14749 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014750
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010014751crc32([<avalanche>])
14752 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
14753 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14754 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14755 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14756 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14757 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
14758 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
14759 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
14760 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
14761 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014762 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
14763
14764crc32c([<avalanche>])
14765 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
14766 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14767 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14768 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
14769 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
14770 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
14771 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
14772 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010014773
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020014774cut_crlf
14775 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
14776 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
14777 updated.
14778
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010014779da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014780 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
14781 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
14782 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
14783 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000014784 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014785 configuration language.
14786
14787 Example:
14788 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020014789 bind *:8881
14790 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000014791 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014792
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010014793debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
14794 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
14795 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
14796 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
14797 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
14798 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
14799 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
14800 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
14801 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
14802 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
14803 printable sample types.
14804
14805 Example:
14806 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020014807
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020014808digest(<algorithm>)
14809 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
14810 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
14811
14812 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
14813 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
14814
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014815div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014816 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14817 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014818 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014819 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
14820 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014821 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014822 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14823 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14824 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14825 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014826 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014827 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014828
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014829djb2([<avalanche>])
14830 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
14831 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14832 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14833 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14834 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14835 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14836 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014837 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
14838 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014839
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014840even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014841 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014842 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
14843
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014844field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14845 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
14846 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
14847 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
14848 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
14849 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
14850 fields.
14851
14852 Example :
14853 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
14854 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14855 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
14856 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
14857 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010014858
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014859hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014860 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014861 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014862 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014863 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010014864
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014865hex2i
14866 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014867 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014868
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020014869htonl
14870 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
14871 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
14872 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
14873 unsigned 32-bit integer.
14874
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020014875hmac(<algorithm>, <key>)
14876 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
14877 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
14878 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
14879 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
14880
14881 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
14882 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
14883
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010014884http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014885 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14886 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014887 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
14888 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
14889 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
14890 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
14891 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
14892 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
14893 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
14894 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014895
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014896in_table(<table>)
14897 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14898 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
14899 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014900 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014901 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
14902
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014903ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
14904 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014905 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014906 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
14907 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
14908 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
14909 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
14910 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014911
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014912json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014913 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014914 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014915 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014916 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
14917 of errors:
14918 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
14919 bytes, ...)
14920 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
14921 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
14922
14923 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
14924 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
14925 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
14926 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
14927 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
14928 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014929 - "ascii" : never fails;
14930 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
14931 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014932 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014933 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014934 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
14935 characters corresponding to the other errors.
14936
14937 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014938 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014939
14940 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014941 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014942 capture request header user-agent len 150
14943 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014944
14945 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
14946 GET / HTTP/1.0
14947 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
14948
14949 Output log:
14950 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
14951
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014952language(<value>[,<default>])
14953 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
14954 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
14955 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
14956 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
14957 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
14958 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
14959 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
14960 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
14961 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014962 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014963 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
14964 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014965
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014966 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014967
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014968 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
14969 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014970
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014971 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
14972 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
14973 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
14974 use_backend spanish if es
14975 use_backend french if fr
14976 use_backend english if en
14977 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014978
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010014979length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010014980 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
14981 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14982 type. The result is of type integer.
14983
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014984lower
14985 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
14986 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14987 type. The result is of type string.
14988
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014989ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
14990 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14991 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
14992 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14993 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14994 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14995 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
14996
14997 Example :
14998
14999 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015000 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015001 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15002
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020015003ltrim(<chars>)
15004 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
15005 representation of the input sample.
15006
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015007map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15008map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15009map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15010 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
15011 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
15012 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
15013 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
15014 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
15015 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
15016 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
15017 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015018
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015019 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
15020 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
15021 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015022
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015023 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015024 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015025
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015026 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
15027 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15028 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
15029 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020015030 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
15031 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015032 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
15033 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15034 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
15035 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15036 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
15037 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15038 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
15039 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080015040 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
15041 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15042 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015043 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15044 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
15045 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15046 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
15047 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015048
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010015049 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
15050 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
15051 the corresponding match text.
15052
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015053 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
15054 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
15055 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
15056 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
15057 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015058
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015059 Example :
15060
15061 # this is a comment and is ignored
15062 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
15063 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
15064 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
15065 | | | `---------- value
15066 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
15067 | `---------------------------- key
15068 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
15069
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015070mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015071 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15072 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015073 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015074 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015075 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015076 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15077 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15078 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15079 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015080 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015081 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015082
15083mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015084 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020015085 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
15086 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015087 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015088 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015089 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015090 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15091 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15092 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15093 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015094 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015095 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015096
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010015097nbsrv
15098 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
15099 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
15100 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
15101 map lookup.
15102
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015103neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015104 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
15105 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
15106 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
15107 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015108
15109not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015110 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015111 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015112 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015113 absence of a flag).
15114
15115odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015116 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015117 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
15118
15119or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015120 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015121 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015122 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15123 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015124 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015125 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15126 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15127 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15128 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015129 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015130 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015131
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015132protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
15133 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
15134 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
15135 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
15136 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
15137 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15138 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15139 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15140 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
15141 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
15142 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15143 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
15144
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010015145regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015146 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
15147 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
15148 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
15149 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
15150 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
15151 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
15152 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
15153 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
15154 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015155 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
15156 of characters with other ones.
15157
15158 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
15159 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
15160 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
15161 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
15162 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
15163 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015164
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015165 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015166
15167 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
15168 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
15169 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015170 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015171
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015172 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
15173 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
15174
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015175 # capture groups and backreferences
15176 # both lines do the same.
15177 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)]'
15178 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
15179
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015180capture-req(<id>)
15181 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
15182 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15183
15184 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015185 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15186 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015187
15188capture-res(<id>)
15189 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
15190 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15191
15192 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015193 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15194 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015195
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020015196rtrim(<chars>)
15197 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
15198 of the input sample.
15199
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015200sdbm([<avalanche>])
15201 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
15202 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15203 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15204 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15205 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15206 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15207 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015208 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
15209 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015210
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015211secure_memcmp(<var>)
15212 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
15213 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
15214 match.
15215
15216 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
15217 performed in constant time.
15218
15219 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15220 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15221
15222 Example :
15223
15224 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
15225 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
15226 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
15227 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
15228
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015229set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015230 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
15231 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
15232 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015233 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015234 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15235 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015236 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015237 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15238 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015239 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015240 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015241
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015242sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015243 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015244 sample with length of 20 bytes.
15245
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015246sha2([<bits>])
15247 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
15248 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
15249
15250 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
15251 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
15252
15253 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15254 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15255
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020015256srv_queue
15257 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
15258 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
15259 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
15260 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
15261 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
15262
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015263strcmp(<var>)
15264 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
15265 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
15266 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
15267 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
15268 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
15269 shorter).
15270
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015271 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
15272 strings in constant time.
15273
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015274 Example :
15275
15276 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
15277 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
15278 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
15279
15280
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015281sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015282 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
15283 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015284 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015285 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
15286 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015287 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015288 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15289 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015290 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015291 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15292 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015293 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015294 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015295
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015296table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
15297 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15298 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15299 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
15300 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15301 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15302 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
15303
15304
15305table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
15306 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15307 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15308 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
15309 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15310 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15311 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
15312
15313table_conn_cnt(<table>)
15314 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15315 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015316 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015317 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
15318 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15319
15320table_conn_cur(<table>)
15321 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15322 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15323 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15324 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15325 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
15326
15327table_conn_rate(<table>)
15328 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15329 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15330 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
15331 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15332 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
15333
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015334table_gpt0(<table>)
15335 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15336 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
15337 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15338 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15339 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
15340
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015341table_gpc0(<table>)
15342 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15343 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15344 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15345 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15346 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
15347
15348table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
15349 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15350 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15351 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
15352 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15353 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
15354 sample fetch keyword.
15355
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015356table_gpc1(<table>)
15357 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15358 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15359 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
15360 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15361 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
15362
15363table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
15364 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15365 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15366 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
15367 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15368 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
15369 sample fetch keyword.
15370
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015371table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
15372 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15373 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015374 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015375 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15376 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15377
15378table_http_err_rate(<table>)
15379 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15380 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15381 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
15382 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
15383 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
15384 keyword.
15385
15386table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
15387 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15388 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015389 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015390 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
15391 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15392
15393table_http_req_rate(<table>)
15394 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15395 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15396 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
15397 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
15398 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
15399 keyword.
15400
15401table_kbytes_in(<table>)
15402 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15403 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015404 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015405 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15406 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15407 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
15408 keyword.
15409
15410table_kbytes_out(<table>)
15411 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15412 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015413 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015414 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15415 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15416 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
15417 keyword.
15418
15419table_server_id(<table>)
15420 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15421 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15422 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
15423 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
15424 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
15425 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
15426
15427table_sess_cnt(<table>)
15428 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15429 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015430 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015431 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
15432 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15433 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
15434 keyword.
15435
15436table_sess_rate(<table>)
15437 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15438 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15439 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
15440 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
15441 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15442 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
15443 keyword.
15444
15445table_trackers(<table>)
15446 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15447 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15448 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15449 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
15450 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
15451 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
15452 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
15453 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
15454 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
15455 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
15456
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015457upper
15458 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
15459 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15460 type. The result is of type string.
15461
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020015462url_dec([<in_form>])
15463 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
15464 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
15465 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
15466 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
15467 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
15468 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020015469
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015470ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015471 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015472 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
15473 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
15474 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015475 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15476 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15477 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15478 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015479 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015480 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15481 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015482
15483 Example:
15484 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
15485 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
15486
15487 message Point {
15488 int32 latitude = 1;
15489 int32 longitude = 2;
15490 }
15491
15492 message PPoint {
15493 Point point = 59;
15494 }
15495
15496 message Rectangle {
15497 // One corner of the rectangle.
15498 PPoint lo = 48;
15499 // The other corner of the rectangle.
15500 PPoint hi = 49;
15501 }
15502
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015503 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
15504 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
15505 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015506
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015507 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15508 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015509 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015510 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
15511
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015512 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015513
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015514 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015515
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015516 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
15517 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15518 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015519
15520 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
15521 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
15522 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
15523
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015524 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
15525 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
15526 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015527
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015528
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010015529unset-var(<var name>)
15530 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
15531 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
15532 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
15533 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15534 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
15535 response),
15536 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15537 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
15538 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
15539 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
15540
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015541utime(<format>[,<offset>])
15542 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15543 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
15544 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15545 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15546 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15547 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
15548
15549 Example :
15550
15551 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015552 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015553 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15554
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015555word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15556 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
15557 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
15558 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015559 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015560 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
15561 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
15562
15563 Example :
15564 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
15565 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15566 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
15567 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
15568 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015569 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010015570
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015571wt6([<avalanche>])
15572 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
15573 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15574 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15575 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15576 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15577 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15578 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015579 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
15580 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015581
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015582xor(<value>)
15583 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015584 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015585 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015586 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015587 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015588 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15589 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015590 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015591 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15592 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015593 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015594 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015595
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010015596xxh32([<seed>])
15597 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
15598 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15599 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15600 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15601 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15602 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15603 as cryptographically secure.
15604
15605xxh64([<seed>])
15606 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
15607 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15608 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15609 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15610 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15611 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15612 as cryptographically secure.
15613
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015614
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200156157.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015616--------------------------------------------
15617
15618A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
15619not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
15620"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
15621The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
15622
15623always_false : boolean
15624 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15625 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15626
15627always_true : boolean
15628 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15629 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15630
15631avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015632 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015633 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
15634 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
15635 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
15636 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
15637 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
15638 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
15639 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
15640 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
15641 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
15642 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
15643 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
15644 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
15645 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010015646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015647be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015648 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
15649 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
15650 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
15651 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015652 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
15653
15654be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
15655 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15656 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
15657 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
15658 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
15659 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015660 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
15661 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015662
15663 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
15664 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
15665 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015666
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015667be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
15668 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15669 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
15670 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015671 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015672 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
15673 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015674
15675 Example :
15676 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
15677 backend dynamic
15678 mode http
15679 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
15680 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015681
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015682bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015683 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
15684 of the string.
15685
15686bool(<bool>) : bool
15687 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
15688 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
15689
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015690connslots([<backend>]) : integer
15691 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015692 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015693 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
15694 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050015695
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015696 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015697 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015698 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
15699
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015700 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
15701 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015702
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015703 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015704 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015705 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015706 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015707 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015708 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015709 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015710
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015711 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
15712 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015713 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015714 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015715
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015716cpu_calls : integer
15717 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
15718 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
15719 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
15720 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
15721 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
15722 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
15723
15724cpu_ns_avg : integer
15725 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
15726 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
15727 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
15728 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
15729 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
15730 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
15731 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
15732 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
15733 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
15734 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
15735 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
15736
15737cpu_ns_tot : integer
15738 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
15739 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
15740 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
15741 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
15742 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
15743 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
15744 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
15745 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
15746 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
15747 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
15748 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
15749 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
15750 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
15751
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015752date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020015753 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015754
15755 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
15756 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
15757 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020015758 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
15759
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015760 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
15761 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
15762 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
15763 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
15764 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
15765
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020015766 Example :
15767
15768 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
15769 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020015770
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015771 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
15772 # millisecond granularity
15773 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
15774
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010015775date_us : integer
15776 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
15777 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
15778 from the same timeval structure.
15779
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020015780distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
15781 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
15782 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
15783 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
15784 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
15785 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
15786 list of supported tokens.
15787
15788distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
15789 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
15790 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
15791 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
15792 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
15793 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
15794 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
15795 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
15796 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
15797 supported tokens.
15798
15799 Example :
15800 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
15801 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
15802 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
15803 # send large files to the big farm
15804 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
15805
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020015806env(<name>) : string
15807 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
15808 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
15809 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
15810 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
15811 certain way.
15812
15813 Examples :
15814 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
15815 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
15816
15817 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
15818 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
15819
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015820fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
15821 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015822 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
15823 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015824 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
15825 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015826 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015827 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
15828 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015829
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020015830fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
15831 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
15832 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
15833 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
15834
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015835fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
15836 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15837 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
15838 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
15839 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
15840 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
15841 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
15842 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
15843 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015844
15845 Example :
15846 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
15847 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
15848 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
15849 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
15850 frontend mail
15851 bind :25
15852 mode tcp
15853 maxconn 100
15854 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
15855 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
15856 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
15857 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015858
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010015859hostname : string
15860 Returns the system hostname.
15861
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015862int(<integer>) : signed integer
15863 Returns a signed integer.
15864
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015865ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
15866 Returns an ipv4.
15867
15868ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
15869 Returns an ipv6.
15870
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015871lat_ns_avg : integer
15872 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
15873 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
15874 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
15875 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
15876 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
15877 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
15878 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
15879 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
15880 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020015881 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
15882 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
15883 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
15884 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
15885 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
15886 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015887
15888lat_ns_tot : integer
15889 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
15890 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
15891 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
15892 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
15893 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
15894 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
15895 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
15896 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
15897 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020015898 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
15899 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
15900 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
15901 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
15902 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015903 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
15904 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
15905 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
15906 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
15907 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
15908 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
15909
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015910meth(<method>) : method
15911 Returns a method.
15912
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015913nbproc : integer
15914 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
15915 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
15916 and debugging purposes.
15917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015918nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
15919 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
15920 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
15921 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015922 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
15923 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
15924 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015925
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040015926prio_class : integer
15927 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
15928 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
15929 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
15930
15931prio_offset : integer
15932 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
15933 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
15934 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
15935 set-priority-offset".
15936
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015937proc : integer
15938 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
15939 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
15940 debugging purposes.
15941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015942queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015943 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
15944 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
15945 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015946 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
15947 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
15948 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
15949 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
15950 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
15951
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010015952rand([<range>]) : integer
15953 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
15954 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
15955 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
15956 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
15957 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
15958
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020015959uuid([<version>]) : string
15960 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
15961 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
15962 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
15963
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015964srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15965 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15966 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
15967 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
15968 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
15969 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015970 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
15971 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
15972
15973srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15974 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15975 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
15976 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15977 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
15978 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
15979 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
15980 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
15981
15982 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
15983 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015984
15985srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
15986 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
15987 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
15988 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015989 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015990 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
15991 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
15992 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
15993
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020015994srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15995 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
15996 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15997 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
15998 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
15999 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
16000 fetch methods.
16001
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016002srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16003 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16004 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016005 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016006 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
16007 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016008 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016009 overloading servers).
16010
16011 Example :
16012 # Redirect to a separate back
16013 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
16014 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
16015 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
16016
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016017stopping : boolean
16018 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
16019 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
16020 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
16021
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016022str(<string>) : string
16023 Returns a string.
16024
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016025table_avl([<table>]) : integer
16026 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
16027 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
16028
16029table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16030 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
16031 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
16032 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
16033
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010016034thread : integer
16035 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
16036 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
16037 and debugging purposes.
16038
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016039var(<var-name>) : undefined
16040 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016041 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
16042 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016043 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016044 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16045 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016046 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016047 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16048 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016049 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016050 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016051
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200160527.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016053----------------------------------
16054
16055The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
16056closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
16057methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
16058sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
16059TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016060the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
16061counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020016062"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
16063used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
16064can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
16065Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
16066table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
16067tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
16068currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016069
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010016070bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010016071 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16072 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16073 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
16074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016075be_id : integer
16076 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016077 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16078 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016079
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016080be_name : string
16081 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016082 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16083 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016084
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016085dst : ip
16086 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
16087 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
16088 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
16089 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016090 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
16091 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
16092 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
16093 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
16094 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
16095 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016096
16097dst_conn : integer
16098 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16099 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
16100 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
16101 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
16102 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
16103 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
16104 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
16105 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016106
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016107dst_is_local : boolean
16108 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
16109 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
16110 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
16111 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016112 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016113 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
16114 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
16115 it only once per connection.
16116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016117dst_port : integer
16118 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
16119 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
16120 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
16121 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
16122 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
16123 an HTTP header.
16124
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020016125fc_http_major : integer
16126 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16127 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16128 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
16129
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020016130fc_pp_authority : string
16131 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16132 if any.
16133
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010016134fc_pp_unique_id : string
16135 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16136 if any.
16137
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010016138fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
16139 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
16140 header.
16141
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020016142fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
16143 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
16144 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
16145 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
16146 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16147 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16148 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16149
16150fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
16151 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
16152 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
16153 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
16154 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16155 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16156 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16157
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016158fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016159 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16160 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16161 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16162 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16163
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016164fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016165 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16166 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16167 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16168 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16169
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016170fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016171 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
16172 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16173 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16174 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16175
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016176fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016177 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
16178 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16179 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16180 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16181
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016182fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016183 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
16184 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16185 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16186 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16187
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016188fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016189 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
16190 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16191 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16192 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16193
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020016194fe_defbe : string
16195 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
16196 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
16197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016198fe_id : integer
16199 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010016200 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016201 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16202
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016203fe_name : string
16204 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
16205 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
16206 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16207
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016208sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016209sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16210sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16211sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016212 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
16213 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16214 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
16215
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016216sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016217sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16218sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16219sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016220 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
16221 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16222 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
16223
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016224sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016225sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16226sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16227sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016228 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16229 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016230 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16231 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16232 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016233
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016234 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016235 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16236 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016237 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16238 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
16239 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016240 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16241 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16242
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016243sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16244sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16245sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16246sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16247 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16248 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
16249 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16250 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16251 when a first ACL was verified.
16252
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016253sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016254sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16255sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16256sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016257 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016258 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
16259
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016260sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016261sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16262sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16263sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016264 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16265 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
16266 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
16267
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016268sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016269sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16270sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16271sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016272 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
16273 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
16274 See also src_conn_rate.
16275
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016276sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016277sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16278sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16279sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016280 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016281 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016282
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016283sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16284sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16285sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16286sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16287 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16288 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16289
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016290sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16291sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16292sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16293sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16294 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16295 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
16296
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016297sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016298sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16299sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16300sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016301 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
16302 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16303 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016304 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16305 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16306 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016307
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016308sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16309sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16310sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16311sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16312 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16313 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16314 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16315 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16316 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16317 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16318
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016319sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016320sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16321sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16322sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016323 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016324 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
16325 See also src_http_err_cnt.
16326
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016327sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016328sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16329sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16330sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016331 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
16332 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16333 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
16334 src_http_err_rate.
16335
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016336sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016337sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16338sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16339sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016340 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016341 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16342 src_http_req_cnt.
16343
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016344sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016345sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16346sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16347sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016348 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
16349 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
16350 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16351 src_http_req_rate.
16352
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016353sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016354sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16355sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16356sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016357 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016358 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16359 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16360 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16361 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016362
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016363 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016364 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16365 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016366 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16367
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016368sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16369sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16370sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16371sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16372 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
16373 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16374 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16375 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16376 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
16377
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016378sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016379sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16380sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16381sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016382 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
16383 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16384 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016385
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016386sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016387sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16388sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16389sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016390 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
16391 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16392 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016393
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016394sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016395sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16396sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16397sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016398 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016399 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
16400 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
16401 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016402 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016403 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
16404
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016405sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016406sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16407sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16408sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016409 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
16410 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16411 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
16412 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
16413 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016414 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016415
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016416sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016417sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16418sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16419sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020016420 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
16421 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
16422 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
16423
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016424sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016425sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
16426sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
16427sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016428 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16429 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016430 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016431 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
16432 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016433 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
16434 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
16435 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016437so_id : integer
16438 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
16439 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
16440 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016441
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010016442so_name : string
16443 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
16444 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
16445 strings instead of integers.
16446
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016447src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016448 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016449 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
16450 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
16451 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016452 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
16453 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
16454 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016455 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
16456 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
16457 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
16458 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
16459 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
16460 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
16461 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016462
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016463 Example:
16464 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
16465 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
16466
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016467src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16468 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
16469 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
16470 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016471 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016473src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16474 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
16475 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016476 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016477 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016479src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16480 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16481 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16482 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16483 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16484 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16485 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016486
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016487 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016488 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16489 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
16490 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
16491 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016492 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016493 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16494 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16495
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016496src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16497 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16498 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16499 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16500 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16501 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16502 was verified.
16503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016504src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016505 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016506 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016507 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016508 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016510src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016511 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016512 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16513 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016514 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016515
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016516src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16517 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
16518 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16519 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016520 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016521
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016522src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016523 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016524 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016525 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016526 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016527
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016528src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16529 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16530 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16531 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16532 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
16533
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016534src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16535 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16536 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16537 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16538 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
16539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016540src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016541 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016542 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016543 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16544 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016545 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16546 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16547 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016548
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016549src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16550 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16551 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16552 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16553 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16554 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16555 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16556 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016558src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016559 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016560 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016561 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016562 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016563 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016565src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16566 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
16567 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16568 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16569 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016570 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016572src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016573 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016574 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16575 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016576 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016577
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016578src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16579 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
16580 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16581 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016582 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016583 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016584
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016585src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16586 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16587 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16588 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016589 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016590 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16591 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016592
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016593 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016594 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016595 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016596 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016597
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016598src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16599 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16600 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16601 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
16602 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16603 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16604 connection when a first ACL was verified.
16605
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016606src_is_local : boolean
16607 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
16608 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
16609 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
16610 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016611 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016612 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
16613 once per connection.
16614
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016615src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016616 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
16617 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
16618 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
16619 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
16620 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016622src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016623 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
16624 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16625 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
16626 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
16627 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016629src_port : integer
16630 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
16631 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
16632 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
16633 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016635src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016636 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016637 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16638 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
16639 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016640 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016641
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016642src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16643 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
16644 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16645 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16646 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016647 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016649src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16650 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
16651 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
16652 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
16653 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
16654 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
16655 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
16656 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
16657 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016658
16659 Example :
16660 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
16661 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
16662 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
16663 listen ssh
16664 bind :22
16665 mode tcp
16666 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016667 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016668 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016669 server local 127.0.0.1:22
16670
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016671srv_id : integer
16672 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
16673 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016674 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020016675
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080016676srv_name : string
16677 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
16678 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016679 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080016680
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200166817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016682----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020016683
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016684The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
16685closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
16686when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
16687usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016688future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020016689
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001669051d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
16691 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16692 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16693 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
16694 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16695 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16696
16697 Example :
16698 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
16699 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
16700 # the request.
16701 frontend http-in
16702 bind *:8081
16703 default_backend servers
16704 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16705 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16706
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016707ssl_bc : boolean
16708 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16709 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016710 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
16711 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016712
16713ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
16714 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016715 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
16716 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016717
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016718ssl_bc_alpn : string
16719 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
16720 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020016721 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016722 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
16723 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
16724 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
16725 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
16726 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016727 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
16728 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016729
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016730ssl_bc_cipher : string
16731 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016732 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
16733 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016734
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016735ssl_bc_client_random : binary
16736 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
16737 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16738 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016739 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016740
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010016741ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
16742 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16743 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016744 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
16745 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010016746
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016747ssl_bc_npn : string
16748 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
16749 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020016750 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016751 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
16752 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
16753 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
16754 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016755 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
16756 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016757
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016758ssl_bc_protocol : string
16759 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016760 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
16761 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016762
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016763ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016764 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016765 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016766 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
16767 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016768
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016769ssl_bc_server_random : binary
16770 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
16771 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16772 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016773 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016774
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016775ssl_bc_session_id : binary
16776 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
16777 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016778 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
16779 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016780
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016781ssl_bc_session_key : binary
16782 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
16783 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
16784 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016785 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016786
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016787ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
16788 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016789 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
16790 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016791
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016792ssl_c_ca_err : integer
16793 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16794 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
16795 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
16796 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
16797 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020016798
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016799ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
16800 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16801 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
16802 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
16803 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016804
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010016805ssl_c_der : binary
16806 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
16807 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16808 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
16809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016810ssl_c_err : integer
16811 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16812 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
16813 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
16814 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
16815 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016816
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016817ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016818 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16819 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
16820 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16821 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16822 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16823 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16824 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16825 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016826 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16827 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16828 LDAP v3.
16829 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16830 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016832ssl_c_key_alg : string
16833 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
16834 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16835 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016837ssl_c_notafter : string
16838 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
16839 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16840 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016842ssl_c_notbefore : string
16843 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
16844 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16845 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010016846
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016847ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016848 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16849 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
16850 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16851 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16852 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16853 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16854 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16855 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016856 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16857 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16858 LDAP v3.
16859 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16860 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010016861
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016862ssl_c_serial : binary
16863 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
16864 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16865 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016867ssl_c_sha1 : binary
16868 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
16869 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
16870 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020016871 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
16872 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
16873
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016874 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020016875 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016877ssl_c_sig_alg : string
16878 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
16879 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16880 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016881
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016882ssl_c_used : boolean
16883 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
16884 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016886ssl_c_verify : integer
16887 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
16888 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
16889 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
16890 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016892ssl_c_version : integer
16893 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
16894 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016895
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010016896ssl_f_der : binary
16897 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
16898 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16899 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
16900
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016901ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016902 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16903 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
16904 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16905 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016906 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016907 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16908 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16909 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016910 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16911 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16912 LDAP v3.
16913 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16914 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016915
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016916ssl_f_key_alg : string
16917 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
16918 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
16919 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016921ssl_f_notafter : string
16922 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
16923 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16924 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016926ssl_f_notbefore : string
16927 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
16928 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16929 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016930
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016931ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016932 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16933 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
16934 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16935 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16936 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16937 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16938 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16939 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016940 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16941 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16942 LDAP v3.
16943 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16944 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016946ssl_f_serial : binary
16947 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16948 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16949 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016950
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020016951ssl_f_sha1 : binary
16952 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
16953 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
16954 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
16955
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016956ssl_f_sig_alg : string
16957 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
16958 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16959 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016961ssl_f_version : integer
16962 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16963 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16964
16965ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016966 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16967 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
16968 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
16969
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016970 Example :
16971 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
16972 listen http-https
16973 bind :80
16974 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
16975 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
16976
16977ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
16978 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
16979 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16980
16981ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016982 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016983 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
16984 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
16985 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
16986 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
16987 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
16988 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
16989 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
16990 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
16991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016992ssl_fc_cipher : string
16993 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
16994 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020016995
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016996ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
16997 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
16998 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016999 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017000
17001ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
17002 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
17003 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017004 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017005
17006ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
17007 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
17008 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
17009 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017010 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020017011 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017012
17013ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
17014 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
17015 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017016 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017017
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017018ssl_fc_client_random : binary
17019 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17020 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17021 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017023ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017024 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
17025 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010017026 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
17027 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
17028 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
17029 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017030
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020017031ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
17032 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
17033 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
17034 wait until the handshake happened.
17035
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017036ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
17037 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017038 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
17039 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017040 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017041 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017042
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020017043ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017044 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010017045 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
17046 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017047
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017048ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017049 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017050 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
17051 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
17052 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
17053 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
17054 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
17055 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
17056 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020017057
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017058ssl_fc_protocol : string
17059 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
17060 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017061
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017062ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017063 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017064 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
17065 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017066
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017067ssl_fc_server_random : binary
17068 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17069 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17070 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17071
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017072ssl_fc_session_id : binary
17073 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
17074 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
17075 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
17076 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017077
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017078ssl_fc_session_key : binary
17079 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
17080 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17081 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
17082 BoringSSL.
17083
17084
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017085ssl_fc_sni : string
17086 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
17087 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
17088 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
17089 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
17090 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
17091
17092 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
17093 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
17094 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017095 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020017096 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017097
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017098 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017099 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
17100 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020017101
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017102ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
17103 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
17104 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017105
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017106ssl_s_der : binary
17107 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
17108 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17109 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17110
17111ssl_s_key_alg : string
17112 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17113 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
17114 SSL/TLS transport layer.
17115
17116ssl_s_notafter : string
17117 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
17118 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17119 transport layer.
17120
17121ssl_s_notbefore : string
17122 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
17123 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17124 transport layer.
17125
17126ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17127 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17128 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17129 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17130 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17131 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17132 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017133 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17134 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017135 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17136 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17137 LDAP v3.
17138 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17139 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17140
17141ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17142 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17143 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17144 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17145 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17146 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17147 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017148 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17149 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017150 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17151 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17152 LDAP v3.
17153 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17154 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17155
17156ssl_s_serial : binary
17157 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
17158 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17159 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17160
17161ssl_s_sha1 : binary
17162 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
17163 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17164 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17165
17166ssl_s_sig_alg : string
17167 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17168 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17169 layer.
17170
17171ssl_s_version : integer
17172 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
17173 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017174
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200171757.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017176------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017178Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
17179sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
17180only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
17181For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
17182be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
17183can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
17184sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
17185for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
17186content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017187
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017188payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017189 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017190 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
17191 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017193payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
17194 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017195 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017196 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017197
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020017198req.hdrs : string
17199 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
17200 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
17201 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
17202 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
17203
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020017204req.hdrs_bin : binary
17205 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
17206 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
17207 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
17208 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
17209 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
17210 names and values (length of 0 for both).
17211
17212 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
17213
17214 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
17215 str: <int:length><bytes>
17216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017217req.len : integer
17218req_len : integer (deprecated)
17219 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
17220 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
17221 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
17222 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
17223 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
17224 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
17225 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
17226 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017228req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17229 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017230 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
17231 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
17232 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
17233 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017235 ACL alternatives :
17236 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017238req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
17239 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
17240 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
17241 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
17242 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017244 ACL alternatives :
17245 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017247 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017248
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017249req.proto_http : boolean
17250req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
17251 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
17252 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
17253 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
17254 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
17255 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
17256 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
17257 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017258
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017259 Example:
17260 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
17261 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17262 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017263 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017264
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017265req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
17266rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17267 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
17268 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
17269 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
17270 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
17271 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
17272 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
17273 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017275 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
17276 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
17277 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
17278 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
17279 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
17280 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017281
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017282 ACL derivatives :
17283 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017285 Example :
17286 listen tse-farm
17287 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
17288 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
17289 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17290 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
17291 # apply RDP cookie persistence
17292 persist rdp-cookie
17293 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
17294 # This is only useful makes sense if
17295 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
17296 stick-table type string size 204800
17297 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
17298 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
17299 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017301 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
17302 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017304req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
17305rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
17306 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
17307 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
17308 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
17309 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017310
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017311 ACL derivatives :
17312 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017313
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017314req.ssl_alpn : string
17315 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
17316 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
17317 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
17318 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
17319 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
17320 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017321 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017322
17323 Examples :
17324 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
17325 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17326 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017327 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017328 default_backend bk_default
17329
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017330req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
17331 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
17332 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020017333 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
17334 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
17335 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
17336 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
17337 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017338
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017339req.ssl_hello_type : integer
17340req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
17341 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
17342 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
17343 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
17344 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
17345 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
17346 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
17347 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017348
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017349req.ssl_sni : string
17350req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
17351 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
17352 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
17353 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
17354 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
17355 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
17356 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
17357 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
17358 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
17359 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
17360 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
17361 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
17362 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017363
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017364 ACL derivatives :
17365 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017367 Examples :
17368 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
17369 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17370 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
17371 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
17372 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017373
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053017374req.ssl_st_ext : integer
17375 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
17376 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
17377 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
17378 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
17379 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
17380 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
17381 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
17382 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
17383 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
17384
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017385req.ssl_ver : integer
17386req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
17387 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
17388 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
17389 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
17390 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
17391 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
17392 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
17393 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017394 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017395 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017396
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017397 ACL derivatives :
17398 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017399
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020017400res.len : integer
17401 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
17402 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
17403 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
17404 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
17405 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
17406 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
17407 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017408 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020017409
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017410res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17411 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017412 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017413 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017414 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017415 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017416
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017417res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
17418 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
17419 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
17420 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017421 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
17422 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017424 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017425
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020017426res.ssl_hello_type : integer
17427rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
17428 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
17429 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
17430 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
17431 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
17432 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
17433 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
17434 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
17435
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017436wait_end : boolean
17437 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
17438 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017439 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017440 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
17441 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017442 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017443 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
17444 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017445
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017446 Examples :
17447 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
17448 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
17449 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017451 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
17452 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17453 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
17454 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
17455 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
17456 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
17457 tcp-request content reject
17458
17459
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200174607.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017461--------------------------------------
17462
17463It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
17464This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
17465data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
17466its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
17467HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
17468content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
17469to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
17470more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
17471response are indexed.
17472
17473base : string
17474 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
17475 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
17476 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
17477 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
17478 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
17479 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
17480 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
17481 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
17482
17483 ACL derivatives :
17484 base : exact string match
17485 base_beg : prefix match
17486 base_dir : subdir match
17487 base_dom : domain match
17488 base_end : suffix match
17489 base_len : length match
17490 base_reg : regex match
17491 base_sub : substring match
17492
17493base32 : integer
17494 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
17495 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
17496 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017497 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
17498 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
17499 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017500
17501base32+src : binary
17502 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
17503 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
17504 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
17505 per-URL counters.
17506
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010017507capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
17508 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
17509 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
17510 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
17511
17512capture.req.method : string
17513 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
17514 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
17515 because it's allocated.
17516
17517capture.req.uri : string
17518 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
17519 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
17520 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
17521 allocated.
17522
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020017523capture.req.ver : string
17524 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
17525 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
17526 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
17527
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010017528capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
17529 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
17530 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
17531 The first entry is an index of 0.
17532 See also: "capture response header"
17533
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020017534capture.res.ver : string
17535 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
17536 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
17537 persistent flag.
17538
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017539req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017540 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
17541 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
17542 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017543
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020017544req.body_param([<name>) : string
17545 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
17546 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
17547 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
17548 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
17549 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
17550 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
17551 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
17552 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
17553 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
17554 given.
17555
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017556req.body_len : integer
17557 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
17558 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017559 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
17560 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017561
17562req.body_size : integer
17563 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017564 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
17565 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017567req.cook([<name>]) : string
17568cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17569 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17570 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
17571 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
17572 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
17573 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
17574 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
17575 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
17576 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
17577
17578 ACL derivatives :
17579 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
17580 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
17581 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
17582 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
17583 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
17584 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
17585 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
17586 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017588req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17589cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17590 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
17591 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017593req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
17594cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17595 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17596 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
17597 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
17598 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017600cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17601 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17602 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
17603 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
17604 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020017605 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017606 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
17607 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
17608 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
17609 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017610
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017611hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17612 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
17613 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
17614 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
17615 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017616 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017618req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
17619 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
17620 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
17621 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17622 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17623 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17624 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
17625 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
17626 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017628req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17629 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
17630 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17631 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
17632 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017634req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17635 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
17636 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
17637 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17638 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17639 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17640 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
17641 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
17642 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000017643 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017644 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017645 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017647 ACL derivatives :
17648 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
17649 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
17650 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
17651 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
17652 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
17653 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
17654 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
17655 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
17656
17657req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17658hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
17659 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
17660 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
17661 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
17662 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
17663 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
17664 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
17665 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
17666 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
17667 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
17668
17669req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
17670hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
17671 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
17672 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
17673 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
17674 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
17675 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017676 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017677 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
17678 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
17679
17680req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
17681hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
17682 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
17683 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
17684 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
17685 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17686 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17687 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17688 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
17689
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010017690
17691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017692http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
17693 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
17694 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
17695 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
17696 basic auth is supported.
17697
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010017698http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
17699 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
17700 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
17701 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
17702 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017703 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
17704 basic auth is supported.
17705
17706 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010017707 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
17708 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
17709 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
17710 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017711
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017712http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010017713 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
17714 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
17715 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017716
17717http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010017718 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
17719 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
17720 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017721
17722http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010017723 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
17724 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
17725 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017726
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017727http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020017728 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
17729 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017730 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
17731 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020017732
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017733method : integer + string
17734 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
17735 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
17736 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
17737 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
17738 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
17739 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
17740 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017741
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017742 ACL derivatives :
17743 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017744
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017745 Example :
17746 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
17747 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
17748 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017749
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017750path : string
17751 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
17752 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
17753 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
17754 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
17755 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017756 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017757 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017758
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017759 ACL derivatives :
17760 path : exact string match
17761 path_beg : prefix match
17762 path_dir : subdir match
17763 path_dom : domain match
17764 path_end : suffix match
17765 path_len : length match
17766 path_reg : regex match
17767 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017768
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010017769query : string
17770 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
17771 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
17772 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
17773 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017774 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010017775 which stops before the question mark.
17776
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010017777req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
17778 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
17779 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
17780 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
17781 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
17782
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017783req.ver : string
17784req_ver : string (deprecated)
17785 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
17786 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
17787 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017789 ACL derivatives :
17790 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017791
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017792res.body : binary
17793 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
17794 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
17795 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
17796 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
17797
17798res.body_len : integer
17799 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
17800 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
17801 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
17802 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
17803
17804res.body_size : integer
17805 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
17806 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
17807 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
17808 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
17809 useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It may be used in tcp-check
17810 based expect rules.
17811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017812res.comp : boolean
17813 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
17814 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
17815 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017817res.comp_algo : string
17818 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
17819 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
17820 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017822res.cook([<name>]) : string
17823scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17824 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17825 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017826 specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may be used in tcp-check
17827 based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020017828
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017829 ACL derivatives :
17830 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020017831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017832res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17833scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17834 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
17835 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017836 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses. It may
17837 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017838
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017839res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
17840scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17841 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17842 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017843 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may
17844 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017845
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017846res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17847 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
17848 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
17849 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
17850 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
17851 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
17852 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
17853 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
17854 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017855 Expires. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017857res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17858 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
17859 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17860 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
17861 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017862 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in
17863 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017865res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17866shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
17867 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
17868 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
17869 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
17870 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
17871 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
17872 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
17873 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017874 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in tcp-check based
17875 expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017877 ACL derivatives :
17878 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
17879 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
17880 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
17881 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
17882 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
17883 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
17884 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
17885 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
17886
17887res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17888shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17889 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
17890 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17891 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
17892 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017893 instead. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017894
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017895res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
17896shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
17897 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
17898 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
17899 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
17900 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
17901 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017902 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table. It
17903 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017904
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010017905res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
17906 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
17907 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
17908 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017909 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered. It may be used
17910 in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010017911
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017912res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
17913shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
17914 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
17915 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
17916 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
17917 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
17918 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017919 useful to learn some data into a stick table. It may be used in tcp-check
17920 based expect rules.
17921
17922res.hdrs : string
17923 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
17924 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
17925 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
17926 headers analyzers and for advanced logging. It may also be used in tcp-check
17927 based expect rules.
17928
17929res.hdrs_bin : binary
17930 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
17931 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
17932 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
17933 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
17934 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
17935 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
17936 (length of 0 for both).
17937
17938 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
17939
17940 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
17941 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010017942
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017943res.ver : string
17944resp_ver : string (deprecated)
17945 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017946 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. It may be used in
17947 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017949 ACL derivatives :
17950 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010017951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017952set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17953 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17954 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020017955 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017956 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010017957
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017958 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
17959 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010017960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017961status : integer
17962 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
17963 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017964 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx. It may be used in
17965 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017966
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020017967unique-id : string
17968 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
17969 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
17970 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
17971 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
17972 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
17973 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
17974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017975url : string
17976 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
17977 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
17978 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
17979 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
17980 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
17981 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
17982 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017983
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017984 ACL derivatives :
17985 url : exact string match
17986 url_beg : prefix match
17987 url_dir : subdir match
17988 url_dom : domain match
17989 url_end : suffix match
17990 url_len : length match
17991 url_reg : regex match
17992 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017993
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017994url_ip : ip
17995 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
17996 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
17997 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
17998 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
17999 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
18000 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18001 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018003url_port : integer
18004 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
18005 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
18006 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18007 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018008
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018009urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
18010url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018011 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
18012 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018013 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
18014 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
18015 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
18016 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018017 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
18018 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018019 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
18020 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018022 ACL derivatives :
18023 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
18024 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
18025 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
18026 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
18027 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
18028 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
18029 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
18030 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018031
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018032
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018033 Example :
18034 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
18035 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
18036 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
18037 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018038
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018039urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018040 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
18041 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
18042 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020018043
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020018044url32 : integer
18045 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
18046 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
18047 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
18048 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
18049 is an unsigned integer.
18050
18051url32+src : binary
18052 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
18053 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
18054 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
18055
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020018056
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200180577.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018058---------------------------------------
18059
18060This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
18061used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
18062purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
18063There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
18064or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
18065any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
18066for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
18067
18068internal.htx.data : integer
18069 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
18070 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18071
18072internal.htx.free : integer
18073 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
18074 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18075
18076internal.htx.free_data : integer
18077 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
18078 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18079
18080internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
18081 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
18082 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
18083 chosen depending on the sample direction.
18084
18085internal.htx.nbblks : integer
18086 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
18087 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18088
18089internal.htx.size : integer
18090 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
18091 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18092
18093internal.htx.used : integer
18094 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
18095 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18096 direction.
18097
18098internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
18099 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18100 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
18101 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
18102 of the special value :
18103 * head : The oldest inserted block
18104 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018105 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018106
18107internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
18108 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18109 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
18110 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
18111 integer or one of the special value :
18112 * head : The oldest inserted block
18113 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018114 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018115
18116internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
18117 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18118 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
18119 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18120 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18121
18122 * head : The oldest inserted block
18123 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018124 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018125
18126internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
18127 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18128 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18129 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18130 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18131
18132 * head : The oldest inserted block
18133 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018134 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018135
18136internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
18137 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18138 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18139 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18140 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18141
18142 * head : The oldest inserted block
18143 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018144 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018145
18146internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
18147 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
18148 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
18149 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18150 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18151
18152 * head : The oldest inserted block
18153 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018154 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018155
18156internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
18157 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
18158 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
18159 it returns false.
18160
18161
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200181627.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018163---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018164
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018165Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
18166every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020018167order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018168
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018169ACL name Equivalent to Usage
18170---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018171FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020018172HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018173HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
18174HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018175HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
18176HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
18177HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
18178HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
18179LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018180METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018181METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018182METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
18183METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
18184METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
18185METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018186METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018187METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018188RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018189REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018190TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018191WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
18192---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018193
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010018194
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200181958. Logging
18196----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018197
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018198One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
18199provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
18200very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
18201provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
18202state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018203to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018204headers.
18205
18206In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
18207about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
18208send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
18209
18210 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
18211 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
18212 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
18213 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
18214 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018215 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060018216 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018217
18218The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
18219allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
18220as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
18221while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
18222real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
18223delay.
18224
18225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182268.1. Log levels
18227---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018228
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018229TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018230source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018231HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
18232in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
18233track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
18234syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
18235about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018236
18237
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182388.2. Log formats
18239----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018240
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018241HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018242and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
18243slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
18244options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018245
18246 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
18247 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
18248 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
18249 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
18250 extents.
18251
18252 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
18253 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
18254 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
18255 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
18256 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
18257
18258 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
18259 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
18260 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
18261 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
18262 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
18263
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020018264 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
18265 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
18266 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
18267 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
18268
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018269 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
18270
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018271Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
18272specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
18273field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
18274servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
18275always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
18276identifier.
18277
18278Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
18279 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
18280 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
18281 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
18282 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
18283
18284
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182858.2.1. Default log format
18286-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018287
18288This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
18289as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
18290format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
18291
18292 Example :
18293 listen www
18294 mode http
18295 log global
18296 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18297
18298 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
18299 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
18300 (www/HTTP)
18301
18302 Field Format Extract from the example above
18303 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
18304 2 'Connect from' Connect from
18305 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
18306 4 'to' to
18307 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
18308 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
18309
18310Detailed fields description :
18311 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
18312 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
18313 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
18314 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
18315 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18316 and processed the connection.
18317 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
18318
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018319In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
18320"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
18321connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
18322
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018323It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
18324will eventually disappear.
18325
18326
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183278.2.2. TCP log format
18328---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018329
18330The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
18331is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
18332information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
18333counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
18334emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
18335environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
18336the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
18337sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018338specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
18339not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
18340fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
18341marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018342
18343 Example :
18344 frontend fnt
18345 mode tcp
18346 option tcplog
18347 log global
18348 default_backend bck
18349
18350 backend bck
18351 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18352
18353 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
18354 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
18355 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
18356
18357 Field Format Extract from the example above
18358 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
18359 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
18360 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
18361 4 frontend_name fnt
18362 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
18363 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
18364 7 bytes_read* 212
18365 8 termination_state --
18366 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
18367 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
18368
18369Detailed fields description :
18370 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018371 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
18372 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
18373 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018374 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018375 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018376 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018377
18378 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018379 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
18380 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
18381 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018382
18383 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
18384 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
18385 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018386 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
18387 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
18388 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
18389 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018390
18391 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18392 and processed the connection.
18393
18394 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
18395 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
18396 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
18397 applications.
18398
18399 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
18400 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
18401 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
18402 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
18403 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
18404
18405 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
18406 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
18407 See "Timers" below for more details.
18408
18409 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
18410 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
18411 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
18412 "Timers" below for more details.
18413
18414 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018415 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018416 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
18417 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
18418 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
18419 details.
18420
18421 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
18422 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
18423 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
18424 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
18425 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
18426
18427 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
18428 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
18429 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
18430 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
18431 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
18432 for more details.
18433
18434 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018435 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018436 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
18437 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
18438 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018439 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018440
18441 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
18442 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
18443 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
18444 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
18445 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
18446 caused by a denial of service attack.
18447
18448 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
18449 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
18450 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
18451 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
18452 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
18453 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
18454 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
18455 denial of service attack.
18456
18457 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
18458 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
18459 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
18460 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
18461 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
18462 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
18463 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
18464 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
18465 be processed than on other servers.
18466
18467 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
18468 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
18469 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
18470 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
18471 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
18472 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
18473 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
18474 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
18475 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
18476 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
18477 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
18478 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
18479 should not be attributed to the logged server.
18480
18481 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18482 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
18483 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
18484 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
18485 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
18486 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018487 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018488 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
18489
18490 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18491 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
18492 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
18493 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
18494 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
18495 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018496 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018497 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
18498 occurs.
18499
18500
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185018.2.3. HTTP log format
18502----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018503
18504The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
18505is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
18506the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
18507are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
18508emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
18509generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
18510"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
18511which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018512frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
18513is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018514
18515Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
18516slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
18517with a star ('*') after the field name below.
18518
18519 Example :
18520 frontend http-in
18521 mode http
18522 option httplog
18523 log global
18524 default_backend bck
18525
18526 backend static
18527 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18528
18529 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
18530 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
18531 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018532 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018533
18534 Field Format Extract from the example above
18535 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
18536 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018537 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018538 4 frontend_name http-in
18539 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018540 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018541 7 status_code 200
18542 8 bytes_read* 2750
18543 9 captured_request_cookie -
18544 10 captured_response_cookie -
18545 11 termination_state ----
18546 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
18547 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
18548 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
18549 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
18550 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018551
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018552Detailed fields description :
18553 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018554 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
18555 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
18556 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018557 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018558 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018559 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018560
18561 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018562 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
18563 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
18564 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018565
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018566 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
18567 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018568
18569 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18570 and processed the connection.
18571
18572 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
18573 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
18574 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
18575
18576 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
18577 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
18578 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
18579 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
18580 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
18581 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
18582
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018583 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
18584 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
18585 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018586 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018587 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
18588 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018589 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
18590 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018591
18592 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
18593 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018594 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018595
18596 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
18597 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018598 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
18599 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018600
18601 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
18602 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
18603 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
18604 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
18605 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018606 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
18607 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018608
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018609 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
18610 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
18611 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
18612 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
18613 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
18614 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
18615 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018616 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018617
18618 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
18619 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
18620 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
18621
18622 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
18623 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018624 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018625 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
18626 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
18627 overflowing.
18628
18629 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
18630 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
18631 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
18632 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
18633 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
18634 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
18635 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
18636 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
18637
18638 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
18639 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
18640 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
18641 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
18642 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
18643 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
18644 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
18645 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
18646
18647 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
18648 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
18649 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
18650 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
18651 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
18652 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
18653 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
18654
18655 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018656 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018657 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
18658 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
18659 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018660 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018661 system.
18662
18663 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
18664 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
18665 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
18666 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
18667 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
18668 caused by a denial of service attack.
18669
18670 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
18671 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
18672 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
18673 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
18674 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
18675 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
18676 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
18677 denial of service attack.
18678
18679 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
18680 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
18681 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
18682 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
18683 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
18684 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
18685 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
18686 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
18687 processed than on other servers.
18688
18689 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
18690 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
18691 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
18692 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
18693 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
18694 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
18695 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
18696 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
18697 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
18698 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
18699 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
18700 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
18701 should not be attributed to the logged server.
18702
18703 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18704 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
18705 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
18706 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
18707 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
18708 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018709 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018710 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
18711
18712 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18713 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
18714 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
18715 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
18716 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
18717 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018718 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018719 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
18720 occurs.
18721
18722 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
18723 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
18724 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
18725 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
18726 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
18727 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
18728 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
18729 cookies" below for more details.
18730
18731 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
18732 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
18733 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
18734 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
18735 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
18736 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
18737 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
18738 and cookies" below for more details.
18739
18740 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
18741 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
18742 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
18743 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
18744 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
18745 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
18746 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
18747 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
18748
18749
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200187508.2.4. Custom log format
18751------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018752
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018753The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018754mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018755
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018756HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018757Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
18758separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
18759prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
18760
18761Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
18762variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018763("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018764
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010018765If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020018766as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010018767less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
18768the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
18769
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020018770Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
18771"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
18772delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
18773preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018774
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018775Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
18776'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
18777https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
18778such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
18779
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018780Flags are :
18781 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018782 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018783 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
18784 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018785
18786 Example:
18787
18788 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
18789 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
18790
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018791 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
18792
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018793At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
18794
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018795 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
18796 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018797
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018798the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018799
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018800 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
18801 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
18802 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018803
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018804and the default TCP format is defined this way :
18805
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018806 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
18807 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018808
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018809Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
18810
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018811 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018812 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018813 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
18814 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
18815 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018816 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
18817 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
18818 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018819 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000018820 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
18821 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000018822 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000018823 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
18824 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010018825 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020018826 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018827 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018828 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018829 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020018830 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080018831 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018832 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
18833 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
18834 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
18835 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
18836 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018837 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018838 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000018839 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018840 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018841 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018842 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
18843 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018844 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
18845 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
18846 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018847 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018848 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
18849 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018850 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018851 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
18852 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
18853 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020018854 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020018855 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018856 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
18857 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
18858 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
18859 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020018860 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018861 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018862 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018863 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010018864 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018865 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018866 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
18867 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
18868 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018869 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018870 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
18871 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018872 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018873 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
18874 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020018875 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018876 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018877 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018878 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018879
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018880 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018881
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010018882
188838.2.5. Error log format
18884-----------------------
18885
18886When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
18887protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
18888By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
18889"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018890will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010018891logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
18892
18893The format looks like this :
18894
18895 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
18896 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
18897 Connection error during SSL handshake
18898
18899 Field Format Extract from the example above
18900 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
18901 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
18902 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
18903 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
18904 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
18905
18906These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
18907failures.
18908
18909
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189108.3. Advanced logging options
18911-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018912
18913Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
18914just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
18915options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
18916for more information about their usage.
18917
18918
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189198.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
18920------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018921
18922It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
18923haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
18924commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
18925monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
18926ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
18927
18928 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
18929 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
18930 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
18931 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
18932
18933 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
18934 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
18935 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018936 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018937 such as other load-balancers.
18938
18939 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
18940 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
18941 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
18942
18943
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189448.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
18945----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018946
18947The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
18948what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
18949or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018950"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018951just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
18952log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
18953after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
18954is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
18955with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
18956with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
18957
18958
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189598.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
18960------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018961
18962Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
18963for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
18964"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
18965retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
18966raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
18967a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
18968file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
18969you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
18970"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
18971
18972
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189738.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
18974--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018975
18976Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
18977multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
18978them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
18979"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
18980logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
18981error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
18982and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
18983too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
18984useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
18985alternative.
18986
18987
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189888.4. Timing events
18989------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018990
18991Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
18992reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
18993the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
18994frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018995mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
18996addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
18997
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010018998Timings events in HTTP mode:
18999
19000 first request 2nd request
19001 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
19002 t tr t tr ...
19003 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
19004 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
19005 :<---- Tq ---->: :
19006 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019007 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010019008 :<--------- Ta --------->:
19009
19010Timings events in TCP mode:
19011
19012 TCP session
19013 |<----------------->|
19014 t t
19015 ---|----|----|----|----|---
19016 | Th Tw Tc Td |
19017 |<------ Tt ------->|
19018
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019019 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019020 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019021 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
19022 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
19023 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019024 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019025 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
19026 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
19027 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
19028 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019029
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019030 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
19031 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
19032 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019033 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
19034 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
19035 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
19036 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
19037 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
19038 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019039
19040 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
19041 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
19042 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
19043 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
19044 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
19045 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
19046 request typed by hand during a test.
19047
19048 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
19049 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019050 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019051 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
19052 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
19053 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
19054 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019055
19056 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
19057 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
19058 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
19059 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
19060 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
19061
19062 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
19063 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
19064 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
19065 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
19066 connection never established.
19067
19068 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
19069 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
19070 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
19071 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
19072 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
19073 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
19074 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
19075 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
19076 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
19077 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
19078 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
19079
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019080 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
19081 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
19082 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
19083 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
19084 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
19085 by subtracting other timers when valid :
19086
19087 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
19088
19089 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
19090 "Ta" can never be negative.
19091
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019092 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
19093 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019094 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
19095 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019096 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019097
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019098 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019099
19100 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019101 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
19102 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019103
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019104 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
19105 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
19106 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
19107 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
19108 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
19109 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
19110 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
19111 prefixed with a '+' sign.
19112
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019113These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
19114protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
19115that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019116due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
19117"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
19118that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019119
19120Most common cases :
19121
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019122 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
19123 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
19124 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
19125 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
19126 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
19127 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
19128 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
19129 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
19130 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
19131 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
19132 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020019133 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019134
19135 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
19136 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
19137 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
19138 of ms on remote networks.
19139
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019140 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
19141 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
19142 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019143
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019144 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
19145 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
19146 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
19147 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
19148 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
19149 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
19150 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
19151 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
19152 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019153
19154Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
19155
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019156 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019157 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019158 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019159
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019160 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019161 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
19162 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
19163
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019164 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019165 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
19166 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
19167 flags.
19168
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019169 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
19170 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019171 Check the session termination flags, then check the
19172 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
19173 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
19174 the client connection was maintained open.
19175
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019176 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019177 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019178 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019179 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
19180
19181
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200191828.5. Session state at disconnection
19183-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019184
19185TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
19186"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
191872-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
19188each of which has a special meaning :
19189
19190 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
19191 session to terminate :
19192
19193 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
19194
19195 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
19196 server explicitly refused it.
19197
19198 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
19199 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
19200 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
19201 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019202 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020019203
19204 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
19205 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019206
19207 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
19208 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
19209 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
19210 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
19211 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
19212
19213 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
19214 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
19215 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
19216 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
19217 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
19218
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090019219 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
19220 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
19221
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070019222 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
19223 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
19224 backup connections when going up.
19225
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020019226 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
19227
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019228 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
19229 send or receive data.
19230
19231 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
19232 send or receive data.
19233
19234 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
19235 with nothing left in the buffers.
19236
19237 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
19238
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010019239 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019240 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
19241
19242 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
19243 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
19244 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
19245 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
19246 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
19247
19248 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
19249 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
19250
19251 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
19252 server (HTTP only).
19253
19254 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
19255
19256 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
19257 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
19258 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
19259
19260 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
19261 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
19262 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
19263
19264 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
19265
19266 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
19267 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
19268
19269 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
19270 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
19271 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
19272
19273 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
19274 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020019275 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
19276 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019277
19278 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
19279 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
19280 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
19281 another server.
19282
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019283 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019284 server.
19285
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019286 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
19287 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
19288 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
19289 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
19290
19291 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
19292 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
19293 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
19294 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
19295
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020019296 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
19297 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
19298 "use-server" rule).
19299
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019300 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
19301
19302 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
19303 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
19304
19305 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
19306
19307 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
19308 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
19309 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
19310
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019311 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
19312 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019313 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019314 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
19315 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
19316
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019317 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
19318
19319 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
19320 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
19321
19322 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
19323
19324 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
19325
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019326The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
19327was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019328helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
19329starvation, attacks, etc...
19330
19331The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
19332alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
19333easier finding and understanding.
19334
19335 Flags Reason
19336
19337 -- Normal termination.
19338
19339 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
19340 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
19341 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
19342 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
19343
19344 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
19345 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
19346 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
19347 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
19348 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
19349 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019350
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019351 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
19352 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020019353 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019354
19355 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
19356 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
19357 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
19358
19359 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
19360 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
19361 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
19362 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
19363 the server takes too long to respond.
19364
19365 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
19366 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
19367 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
19368 long a time to respond.
19369
19370 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
19371 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
19372 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
19373 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019374 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
19375 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019376
19377 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
19378 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
19379 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
19380 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
19381 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020019382 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019383 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
19384 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
19385 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
19386 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
19387 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
19388 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
19389 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
19390 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019391 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019392 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
19393 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
19394 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019395
19396 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
19397 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019398 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
19399 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
19400 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
19401 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019402
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020019403 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
19404 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
19405
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019406 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019407 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
19408 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019409 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019410 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
19411 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
19412
19413 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
19414 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
19415 503 or 504 here.
19416
19417 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
19418 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
19419 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
19420 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
19421 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
19422
19423 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
19424 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019425 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019426 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
19427 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
19428
19429 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
19430 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
19431 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
19432 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
19433 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
19434 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
19435 between haproxy and the server.
19436
19437 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
19438 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
19439 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
19440 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
19441 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
19442 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
19443 solution is to fix the application.
19444
19445 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
19446 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
19447 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
19448 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
19449 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
19450 external attacks.
19451
19452 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
19453 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020019454 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019455 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
19456 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
19457
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019458 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
19459 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
19460 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019461 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020019462 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019463
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019464 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
19465 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
19466 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
19467 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019468 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
19469 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
19470 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
19471 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
19472 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019473
19474 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
19475 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
19476 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
19477 returned an HTTP 403 error.
19478
19479 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
19480 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
19481 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
19482 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
19483
19484 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
19485 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
19486 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
19487 only be solved by proper system tuning.
19488
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019489The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
19490persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
19491important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
19492re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
19493
19494 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
19495
19496 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
19497 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
19498 set on a GET request.
19499
19500 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
19501 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019502 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019503 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
19504
19505 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
19506 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
19507 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
19508
19509 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
19510 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
19511 already got a cookie.
19512
19513 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
19514 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
19515 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
19516 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
19517 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
19518
19519 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
19520 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
19521 new cookie was inserted in the response.
19522
19523 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
19524 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
19525 new cookie was inserted in the response.
19526
19527 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
19528 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
19529
19530 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
19531 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
19532 then advertised in the response.
19533
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019534
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200195358.6. Non-printable characters
19536-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019537
19538In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
19539consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
19540converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
19541prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
19542being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
19543escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
19544is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
19545'}' when logging headers.
19546
19547Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
19548issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
19549containing spaces is "User-Agent".
19550
19551Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
19552the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
19553performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
19554
19555
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200195568.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
19557---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019558
19559Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
19560achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019561section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019562cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
19563the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
19564the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019565locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019566not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
19567user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
19568a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
19569wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
19570
19571 Examples :
19572 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
19573 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
19574
19575 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
19576 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
19577
19578
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200195798.8. Capturing HTTP headers
19580---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019581
19582Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
19583proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
19584the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
19585server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
19586
19587Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
19588response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019589section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019590
19591It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019592time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
19593appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019594are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
19595and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
19596follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
19597request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
19598in the logs.
19599
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019600As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
19601frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
19602an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
19603
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019604 Example :
19605 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
19606 listen proxy-out
19607 mode http
19608 option httplog
19609 option logasap
19610 log global
19611 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
19612
19613 # log the name of the virtual server
19614 capture request header Host len 20
19615
19616 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
19617 capture request header Content-Length len 10
19618
19619 # log the beginning of the referrer
19620 capture request header Referer len 20
19621
19622 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
19623 capture response header Server len 20
19624
19625 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
19626 capture response header Content-Length len 10
19627
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019628 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019629 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
19630
19631 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
19632 capture response header Via len 20
19633
19634 # log the URL location during a redirection
19635 capture response header Location len 20
19636
19637 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
19638 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
19639 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19640 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
19641 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
19642
19643 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
19644 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
19645 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19646 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019647 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019648
19649 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
19650 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
19651 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19652 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
19653 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019654 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019655
19656
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200196578.9. Examples of logs
19658---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019659
19660These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
19661them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
19662reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
19663
19664 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
19665 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
19666 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
19667
19668 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
19669 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
19670
19671 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
19672 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
19673 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
19674
19675 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
19676 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
19677
19678 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
19679 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
19680 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
19681
19682 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019683 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019684 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
19685 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
19686
19687 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
19688 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
19689 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
19690
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020019691 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
19692 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
19693 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
19694 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
19695 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
19696 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019697
19698 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019699 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019700
19701 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
19702 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
19703 Nothing was sent to any server.
19704
19705 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
19706 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
19707
19708 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
19709 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019710 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019711 send a 408 return code to the client.
19712
19713 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
19714 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
19715
19716 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
19717 5 seconds ("c----").
19718
19719 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
19720 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019721 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019722
19723 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019724 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019725 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
19726 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
19727 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
19728 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
19729 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010019730
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020019731
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200197329. Supported filters
19733--------------------
19734
19735Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
19736accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
19737unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
19738
19739See also : "filter"
19740
197419.1. Trace
19742----------
19743
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010019744filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019745
19746 Arguments:
19747 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
19748 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
19749
19750 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
19751 the client and the server. By default, this filter
19752 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
19753 only parses a random amount of the available data.
19754
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019755 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019756 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
19757 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
19758 amount of the parsed data.
19759
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019760 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010019761
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019762This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
19763callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
19764information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
19765filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
19766
19767Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
19768tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
19769a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
19770
19771
197729.2. HTTP compression
19773---------------------
19774
19775filter compression
19776
19777The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
19778keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019779when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
19780fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
19781done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
19782explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
19783filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
19784listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
19785order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019786
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019787See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
19788 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019789
19790
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200197919.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
19792--------------------------------------------
19793
19794filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
19795
19796 Arguments :
19797
19798 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
19799 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
19800 parsed.
19801
19802 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
19803 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
19804 part must be placed in its own scope.
19805
19806The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
19807external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019808streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020019809exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
19810also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
19811
19812SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
19813the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
19814
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019815For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020019816"doc/SPOE.txt".
19817
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100198189.4. Cache
19819----------
19820
19821filter cache <name>
19822
19823 Arguments :
19824
19825 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
19826
19827The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
19828"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019829cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019830other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
19831case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
19832is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
19833filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010019834listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
19835order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010019836
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019837See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
19838 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
19839
19840
198419.5. Fcgi-app
19842-------------
19843
19844filter fcg-app <name>
19845
19846 Arguments :
19847
19848 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
19849
19850The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
19851request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
19852reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
19853used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
19854implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
19855used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
19856fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
19857used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
19858order.
19859
19860See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
19861 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
19862
19863
1986410. FastCGI applications
19865-------------------------
19866
19867HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
19868feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
19869the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
19870FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
19871servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
19872FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
19873backend.
19874
19875HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
19876application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
19877connection.
19878
1987910.1. Setup
19880-----------
19881
1988210.1.1. Fcgi-app section
19883--------------------------
19884
19885fcgi-app <name>
19886 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
19887 document root must be defined.
19888
19889acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
19890 Declare or complete an access list.
19891
19892 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
19893 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
19894 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
19895 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
19896 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
19897
19898docroot <path>
19899 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
19900 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
19901 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
19902
19903index <script-name>
19904 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
19905 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
19906 is an optional setting.
19907
19908 Example :
19909 index index.php
19910
19911log-stderr global
19912log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
19913 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
19914 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
19915
19916 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
19917 default STDERR messages are ignored.
19918
19919pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
19920 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
19921 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
19922 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
19923
19924 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
19925 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
19926 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
19927 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
19928
19929 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
19930 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
19931
19932path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010019933 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010019934 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
19935 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
19936 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
19937 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
19938 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
19939 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
19940 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010019941
19942 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019943 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010019944 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
19945 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
19946 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
19947 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019948
19949 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010019950 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
19951 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019952
19953option get-values
19954no option get-values
19955 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
19956
19957 HAproxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
19958 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
19959
19960 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
19961 application will accept.
19962
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020019963 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
19964 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019965
19966 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050019967 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019968 option is disabled.
19969
19970 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
19971 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
19972 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
19973 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
19974 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
19975 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
19976
19977option keep-conn
19978no option keep-conn
19979 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
19980 sending a response.
19981
19982 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
19983 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
19984
19985option max-reqs <reqs>
19986 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
19987 accept.
19988
19989 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
19990 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
19991 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
19992 to 1.
19993
19994option mpxs-conns
19995no option mpxs-conns
19996 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
19997
19998 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
19999 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
20000
20001set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20002 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
20003 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
20004 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
20005 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20006
20007 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
20008 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
20009 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
20010
20011 Example :
20012 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
20013 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
20014
20015 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
20016
20017
2001810.1.2. Proxy section
20019---------------------
20020
20021use-fcgi-app <name>
20022 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
20023
20024 Arguments :
20025 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
20026
20027 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
20028 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
20029 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
20030 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
20031 application may be defined at a time per backend.
20032
20033 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
20034 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
20035 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
20036 application are evaluated.
20037
20038
2003910.1.3. Example
20040---------------
20041
20042 frontend front-http
20043 mode http
20044 bind *:80
20045 bind *:
20046
20047 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
20048 default_backend back-static
20049
20050 backend back-static
20051 mode http
20052 server www A.B.C.D:80
20053
20054 backend back-dynamic
20055 mode http
20056 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
20057 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
20058
20059 fcgi-app php-fpm
20060 log-stderr global
20061 option keep-conn
20062
20063 docroot /var/www/my-app
20064 index index.php
20065 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
20066
20067
2006810.2. Default parameters
20069------------------------
20070
20071A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
20072the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020073script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020074applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
20075
20076 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20077 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
20078 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
20079 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
20080 | | |
20081 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20082 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
20083 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
20084 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
20085 | | application. |
20086 | | |
20087 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20088 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
20089 | | the request. It may not be set. |
20090 | | |
20091 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20092 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
20093 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
20094 | | the application's configuration. |
20095 | | |
20096 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20097 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
20098 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
20099 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
20100 | | |
20101 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20102 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
20103 | | following the part that identifies the script |
20104 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
20105 | | be defined. |
20106 | | |
20107 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20108 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
20109 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
20110 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
20111 | | is not set too. |
20112 | | |
20113 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20114 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
20115 | | set. |
20116 | | |
20117 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20118 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
20119 | | the request. |
20120 | | |
20121 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20122 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
20123 | | client as part of user authentication. |
20124 | | |
20125 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20126 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
20127 | | script to process the request. |
20128 | | |
20129 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20130 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
20131 | | |
20132 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20133 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
20134 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
20135 | | |
20136 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20137 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
20138 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
20139 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
20140 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
20141 | | |
20142 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20143 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
20144 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
20145 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
20146 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
20147 | | side. |
20148 | | |
20149 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20150 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
20151 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
20152 | | connected to. |
20153 | | |
20154 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20155 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
20156 | | |
20157 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20158 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
20159 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
20160 | | |
20161 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20162
20163
2016410.3. Limitations
20165------------------
20166
20167The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
20168way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
20169during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
20170establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
20171application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
20172or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
20173message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
20174these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
20175and HTTP servers under the same backend.
20176
20177Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
20178request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
20179requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
20180
20181About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
20182into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
20183fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
20184"http-request" ones.
20185
20186Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
20187FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
20188processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
20189must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
20190here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010020191
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020192/*
20193 * Local variables:
20194 * fill-column: 79
20195 * End:
20196 */